breakpoints: add rwp all command
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2022 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @item @b{STLINK-V3PWR}
467 @* This is available standalone.
468 Beside the debugger functionality, the probe includes a SMU (source
469 measurement unit) aimed at analyzing power consumption during code
470 execution. The SMU is not supported by OpenOCD.
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3pwr}
472 @end itemize
473
474 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
475 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
476 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
477 @itemize @bullet
478 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
479 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
480 @end itemize
481
482 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
483 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
484 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
485 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
486
487 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
488 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
489 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
490 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
491 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
492
493 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
494 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
495 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
496
497 @section USB Other
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item @b{USBprog}
500 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
501
502 @item @b{USB - Presto}
503 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
504
505 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
506 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
507
508 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
509 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
510
511 @item @b{angie}
512 @* Link: @url{https://nanoxplore.org/}
513
514 @item @b{Buspirate}
515 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
516
517 @item @b{opendous}
518 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
519
520 @item @b{estick}
521 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
522
523 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
525
526 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
527 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
528 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
529 @end itemize
530
531 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
532
533 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
534 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
535 these on the market.
536
537 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
538 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
539 of USB-based ones.
540
541 @itemize @bullet
542
543 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
544 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
545
546 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
547 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
548 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
549
550 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
551 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
552
553 @item @b{Wiggler2}
554 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
555
556 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
557 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
558
559 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
560 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
561
562 @item @b{arm-jtag}
563 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
564
565 @item @b{chameleon}
566 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
567
568 @item @b{Triton}
569 @* Unknown.
570
571 @item @b{Lattice}
572 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
573 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
574
575 @item @b{flashlink}
576 @* From STMicroelectronics;
577 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
578
579 @end itemize
580
581 @section Other...
582 @itemize @bullet
583
584 @item @b{ep93xx}
585 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
586
587 @item @b{at91rm9200}
588 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
589
590 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
591 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
592
593 @item @b{imx_gpio}
594 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
595
596 @item @b{am335xgpio}
597 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @item @b{vdebug}
604 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
605 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
606 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The driver supports
607 JTAG and DAP-level transports.
608
609 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
610 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
611 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
612 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
613 emulation model of target hardware.
614
615 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
616 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
617
618 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
619 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
620
621 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
622 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
623 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
624
625 @item @b{esp_usb_jtag}
626 @* A JTAG driver to communicate with builtin debug modules of Espressif ESP32-C3 and ESP32-S3 chips using OpenOCD.
627
628 @end itemize
629
630 @node About Jim-Tcl
631 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
632 @cindex Jim-Tcl
633 @cindex tcl
634
635 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
636 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
637 command interpreter.
638
639 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
640 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
641 much of anything about Tcl.
642 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
643
644 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
645 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
646 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
647 OpenOCD mailing list.
648
649 @itemize @bullet
650 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
651 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
652 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
653 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
654 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
655 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
656
657 @item @b{Missing Features}
658 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
659 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
660 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
661 enabled in OpenOCD.
662
663 @item @b{Scripts}
664 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
665 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
666 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
667
668 @item @b{Commands}
669 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
670 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
671 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
672 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
673
674 @item @b{Historical Note}
675 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
676 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
677 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
678 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
679
680 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
681 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
682 @end itemize
683
684 @node Running
685 @chapter Running
686 @cindex command line options
687 @cindex logfile
688 @cindex directory search
689
690 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
691 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
692 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
693 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
694 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
695 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
696 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
697
698 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
699 tell it how each debug session should work.
700 The @option{--help} option shows:
701 @verbatim
702 bash$ openocd --help
703
704 --help | -h display this help
705 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
706 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
707 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
708 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
709 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
710 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
711 --command | -c run <command>
712 @end verbatim
713
714 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
715 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
716 To specify one or more different
717 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
718
719 @example
720 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
721 @end example
722
723 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
724 @enumerate
725 @item the current directory,
726 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
727 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
728 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
729 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
730 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
731 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
732 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
733 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
734 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
735 @end enumerate
736 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
737
738 @quotation Note
739 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
740 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
741 @end quotation
742
743 @section Simple setup, no customization
744
745 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
746 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
747 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
748 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
749 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
750
751 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
752 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
753 the server with some variation of one of the following:
754
755 @example
756 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
757 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
758 @end example
759
760 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
761 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
762 If all goes well you'll see output something like
763
764 @example
765 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
766 For bug reports, read
767 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
768 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
769 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
770 @end example
771
772 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
773 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
774 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
775
776 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
777
778 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
779 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
780 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
781 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
782 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
783 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
784 ensure that this always succeeds.
785 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
786 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
787 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
788 and then shut down without acting as a server.
789
790 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
791 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
792 those channels.
793
794 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
795 the @option{-d} option.
796
797 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
798 @option{-c} command line switch.
799
800 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
801 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
802 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
803 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
804 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
805 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
806 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
807
808 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
809 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
810
811 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
812 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
813 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
814 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
815
816 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
817 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
818
819 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
820 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
821 and start the OpenOCD server.
822 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
823 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
824 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
825 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
826
827 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
828
829 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
830 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
831 and a USB cable on the other.
832 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
833 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
834
835 @enumerate
836 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
837 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
838 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
839 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
840 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
841 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
842 debugging host.
843
844 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
845 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
846 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
847 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
848 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
849
850 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
851 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
852 with 1.2 Volt boards.
853
854 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
855 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
856 ways to connect the cable.
857 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
858 Be sure it's firmly connected.
859
860 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
861 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
862 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
863 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
864 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
865 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
866 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
867 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
868
869 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
870 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
871 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
872 but are tedious to set up.
873 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
874 adapter signals to the right board pins.
875
876 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
877 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
878 you are using to run OpenOCD.
879 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
880
881 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
882 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
883 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
884 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
885
886 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
887 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
888 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
889
890 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
891 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
892 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
893 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
894
895 @end enumerate
896
897 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
898 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
899 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
900
901 @section Project Directory
902
903 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
904
905 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
906 single directory for your work with a given board.
907 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
908 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
909 files accessed through semihosting,
910 and for code you upload to the target board.
911 It is also the natural place to write files,
912 such as log files and data you download from the board.
913
914 @section Configuration Basics
915
916 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
917 a variety of ways you can mix them.
918 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
919
920 @itemize
921 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
922 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
923 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
924 @end itemize
925
926 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
927 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
928 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
929
930 @example
931 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
932
933 # GDB can also flash my flash!
934 gdb_memory_map enable
935 gdb_flash_program enable
936
937 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
938 @end example
939
940 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
941
942 @example
943 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
944 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
945 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
946 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
947 @end example
948
949 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
950 each supporting a different development task.
951 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
952 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
953
954 @quotation Important
955 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
956 problems with how it treats variables.
957 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
958 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
959 that can be tested in a later script.
960 @end quotation
961
962 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
963 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
964 to simplify your work.
965
966 @section User Config Files
967 @cindex config file, user
968 @cindex user config file
969 @cindex config file, overview
970
971 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
972 in one place.
973 One of the following will match your situation best:
974
975 @itemize
976 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
977 provided by someone else.
978 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
979 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
980 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
981 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
982 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
983 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
984
985 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
986 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
987
988 @enumerate
989 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
990 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
991 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
992 @end enumerate
993
994 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
995 The first is an interface config file.
996 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
997 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
998 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
999 meet your deadline:
1000
1001 @example
1002 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1003 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1004 @end example
1005
1006 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1007 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1008 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1009 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1010
1011 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1012 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1013 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1014 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1015 target and board
1016 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1017 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1018
1019 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1020 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1021 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1022 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1023
1024 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1025 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1026 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1027 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1028 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1029
1030 @quotation Note
1031 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1032 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1033 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1034 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1035 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1036 @end quotation
1037
1038 @item
1039 You may need to write some C code.
1040 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1041 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1042 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1043 a new chip architecture.
1044 @end itemize
1045
1046 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1047 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1048 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1049
1050 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1051 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1052 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1053 @itemize
1054
1055 @item
1056 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1057 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1058 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1059 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1060
1061 @item
1062 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1063 @cindex vector_catch
1064 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1065 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1066 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1067 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1068 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1069 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1070
1071 @item
1072 You might need to override some defaults.
1073 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1074 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1075
1076 @item
1077 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1078 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1079 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1080 @end itemize
1081
1082 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1083
1084 A few project-specific utility
1085 routines may well speed up your work.
1086 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1087
1088 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1089 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1090 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1091 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1092 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1093 may help:
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1098 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1099 # Leave the CPU halted.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1103 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1104
1105 # Start running.
1106 resume 0x20000000
1107 @}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1111 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1112 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1113 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1114 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1115
1116 @example
1117 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1118 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1119 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1120 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1121 reset init
1122
1123 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1124 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1125 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1126 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1127 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1128 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1129 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1130
1131 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1132 reset run
1133 @}
1134 @end example
1135
1136 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1137 from NAND.
1138 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1139 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1140 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1141
1142 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1143 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1144
1145 @section Target Software Changes
1146
1147 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1148 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1149 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1150 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1151 handling issues like:
1152
1153 @itemize @bullet
1154
1155 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1156 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1157 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1158 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1159 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1160 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1161 your debug sessions.
1162
1163 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1164 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1165 That might however be your only option.
1166
1167 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1168 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1169 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1170 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1171 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1172 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1173 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1174 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1175 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1176 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1177 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1178 instead of the whole thing.
1179 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1180 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1181
1182 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1183 @cindex ARM semihosting
1184 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1185 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1186 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1187 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1188 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1189 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1190 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1191 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1192 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1193 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1194 NAND or SPI flash.
1195
1196 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1197 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1198 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1199 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1200 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1201
1202 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1203 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1204 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1205 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1206 registers which can be used to change various features including
1207 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1208 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1209 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1210 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1211 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1212
1213 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1214 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1215 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1216 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1217 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1218
1219 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1220 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1221 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1222 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1223 early code execution can be debugged
1224 or firmware can be replaced.
1225
1226 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1227 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1228 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1229 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1230 operations like writing to memory.)
1231
1232 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1233 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1234 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1235 various kinds of message.
1236 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1237
1238 @end itemize
1239
1240 @section Target Hardware Setup
1241
1242 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1243 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1244 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1245 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1246 working with.}
1247
1248 Common issues include:
1249
1250 @itemize @bullet
1251
1252 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1253 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1254 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1255 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1256 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1257 or one from a daughtercard).
1258 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1259 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1260
1261 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1262 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1263 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1264 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1265 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1266 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1267
1268 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1269 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1270 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1271 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1272 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1273
1274
1275 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1276 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1277 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1278 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1279 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1280 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1281 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1282
1283 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1284 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1285 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1286 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1287 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1288
1289 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1290 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1291 used to start booting.
1292
1293 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1294 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1295 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1296 multiple audio codec chips).
1297 This interacts with software
1298 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1299 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1300 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1301 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1302 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1303 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1304 audio or video codecs are used.
1305
1306 @end itemize
1307
1308 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1309 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1310 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1311 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1312 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1313 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1314 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1315 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1316 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1317 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1318
1319
1320 @node Config File Guidelines
1321 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1322
1323 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1324 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1325 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1326 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1327
1328 You should find the following directories under
1329 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1330 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1331 @itemize @bullet
1332 @item @file{interface} ...
1333 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1334 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1335 @item @file{board} ...
1336 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1337 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1338
1339 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1340 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1341 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1342 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1343 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1344 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1345 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1346 a CPU and an FPGA.
1347 @item @file{target} ...
1348 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1349 on a chip
1350 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1351 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1352 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1353 the target config file defines all of them.
1354 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1355 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1356 @end itemize
1357
1358 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1359 file may override features in any of the above files by
1360 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1361 commands specific to their situation.
1362
1363 @section Interface Config Files
1364
1365 The user config file
1366 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1367
1368 @example
1369 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1370 @end example
1371
1372 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1373 in use today with OpenOCD.
1374 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1375 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1376
1377 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1378 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1379 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1380 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1381 and need to provide a driver for it.
1382
1383 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1384 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1385 @end deffn
1386
1387 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1388 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1389 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1390 to use @command{find}, instead.
1391 @end deffn
1392
1393 @section Board Config Files
1394 @cindex config file, board
1395 @cindex board config file
1396
1397 The user config file
1398 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1399
1400 @example
1401 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1402 @end example
1403
1404 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1405 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1406 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1407
1408 @enumerate
1409 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1410 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1411 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1412 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1413 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1414 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1415 @end enumerate
1416
1417 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1418 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1419 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1420 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1421
1422 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1423 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1424 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1425 configuration works.
1426
1427 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1428
1429 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1430 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1431 convention on how to use certain variables.
1432
1433 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1434 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1435 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1436 used at will within a target configuration file.
1437
1438 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1439 for a board with three chips:
1440
1441 @example
1442 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1443 set CHIPNAME network
1444 set ENDIAN big
1445 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1446 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1447 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1448 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1449
1450 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1451 set CHIPNAME video
1452 set ENDIAN little
1453 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1454 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1455 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1456 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1457
1458 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1459 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1460 unset ENDIAN
1461 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1462 @end example
1463
1464 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1465 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1466 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1467 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1468 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1469 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1470 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1471 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1472
1473 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1474 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1475 naming collisions.
1476
1477 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1478 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1479 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1480 up other clocks and peripherals.
1481
1482 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1483 @cindex variable names
1484
1485 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1486 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1487 one such chip (as shown above).
1488 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1489 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1490 to promote consistency and
1491 so that board files can override target defaults.
1492
1493 Inputs to target config files include:
1494
1495 @itemize @bullet
1496 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1497 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1498 tap identifier dotted names.
1499 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1500 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1501 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1502 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1503 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1504 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1505 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1506 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1507 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1508 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 Outputs from target config files include:
1512
1513 @itemize @bullet
1514 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1515 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1516 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1517 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1518 specific to that board and that target.
1519 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1520 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1521 @end itemize
1522
1523 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1524 @cindex event, reset-init
1525 @cindex reset-init handler
1526
1527 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1528 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1529 fully set up yet.
1530 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1531 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1532 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1533 handler is one of the most important.
1534
1535 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1536 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1537 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1538 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1539 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1540
1541 @quotation Note
1542 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1543 are included here.
1544 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1545 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1546 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1547 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1548 @end quotation
1549
1550 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1551 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1552 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1553 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1554 those as parameters.
1555 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1556 and disabling the watchdog.
1557 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1558 the next developer doing such work.
1559 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1560
1561 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1562 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1563 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1564 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1565
1566 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1567
1568 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1569 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1570 a low JTAG clock rate.
1571 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1572 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1573 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1574 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1575 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1576 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1577 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1578
1579 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1580 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1581 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1582 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1583 which might be less than that.
1584
1585 @quotation Warning
1586 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1587 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1588 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1589 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1590 @end quotation
1591
1592 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1593 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1594 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1595 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1596 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1597 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1598
1599 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1600 @subsection The init_board procedure
1601 @cindex init_board procedure
1602
1603 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1604 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1605 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1606 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1607 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1608 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1609 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1610 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1611 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1612 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1613 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1614 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1615
1616 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1617 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1618
1619 @example
1620 ### board_file.cfg ###
1621
1622 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1623 source [find target/target.cfg]
1624
1625 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1626 # enables fast on-board clock source
1627 # configures the chip to use it
1628 @}
1629
1630 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1631 proc init_board @{@} @{
1632 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1633
1634 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1635 adapter speed 100
1636 @}
1637
1638 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1639 enable_fast_clock
1640 adapter speed 10000
1641 @}
1642 @}
1643 @end example
1644
1645 @section Target Config Files
1646 @cindex config file, target
1647 @cindex target config file
1648
1649 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1650 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1651 more target config files like this:
1652
1653 @example
1654 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1655 @end example
1656
1657 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1658 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1659 In summary the target files should contain
1660
1661 @enumerate
1662 @item Set defaults
1663 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1664 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1665 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1666 @item On-Chip flash
1667 @end enumerate
1668
1669 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1670 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1671 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1672
1673 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1674 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1675 can talk to the chip.
1676 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1677 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1678 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1679 and other processing engines.
1680
1681 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1682
1683 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1684 letting board config files express environment-specific
1685 differences in how things should be set up.
1686
1687 @example
1688 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1689 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1690 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1691 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1692 @} else @{
1693 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1694 @}
1695
1696 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1697 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1698 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1699 @} else @{
1700 set _ENDIAN little
1701 @}
1702
1703 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1704 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1705 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1706 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1707 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1708 @} else @{
1709 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1710 @}
1711 @end example
1712 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1713
1714 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1715 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1716 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1717
1718 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1719 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1720 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1721
1722 @example
1723 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1724 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1725 @end example
1726
1727 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1728 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1729 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1730 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1731 for taps.
1732
1733 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1734 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1735 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1736 looks (in part) like this:
1737
1738 @example
1739 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1740 @end example
1741
1742 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1743 to source such a config file twice, with different
1744 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1745 it adds a different TAP each time.
1746
1747 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1748 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1749 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1750 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1751
1752 @example
1753 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1754 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1755 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1756 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1757 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1758 @end example
1759
1760 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1761 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1762
1763 @itemize
1764 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1765 plus a JRC to enable them
1766 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1767 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1768 is not currently used)
1769 @end itemize
1770
1771 @subsection Add CPU targets
1772
1773 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1774 GDB and other commands can use it.
1775 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1776 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1777 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1778 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1779
1780 @example
1781 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1782 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1783 @end example
1784
1785 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1786 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1787 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1788 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1789 a work area if you can.
1790 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1791
1792 @example
1793 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1794 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1795 @end example
1796
1797 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1798 @cindex SMP
1799 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1800
1801 @example
1802 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1803 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1804 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1805 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1806 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1807 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1808 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1809 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1810 @end example
1811 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1812 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1815 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1816 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1817 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1818 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1819 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1820 @end itemize
1821
1822 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1823 command have been implemented.
1824 @itemize @bullet
1825 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1826 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1827 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1828 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1829 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1830 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1831 following example.
1832 @end itemize
1833
1834 @example
1835 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1836 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1837 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1839 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1840 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1841 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1842 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1843 > resume
1844 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1845 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1846 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1847 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1848 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1849 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1850 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1851 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1852 @end example
1853
1854
1855 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1856
1857 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1858 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1859 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1860
1861 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1862 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1863 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1864 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1865 both signals.
1866
1867 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1868 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1869 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1870 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1871 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1872 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1873 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1874 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1875 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1876 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1877 not available.)
1878
1879 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1880 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1881 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1882 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1883 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1884 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1885 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1886 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1887
1888 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1889 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1890 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1891 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1892 slower clock than they will use later.
1893 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1894 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1895 than they will use later.
1896 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1897
1898 @quotation Important
1899 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1900 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1901 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1902 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1903 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1904 @end quotation
1905
1906 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1907 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1908 @cindex init_targets procedure
1909
1910 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1911 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1912 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1913 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1914 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1915 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1916 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1917 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1918 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1919
1920 @example
1921 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1924 # basic initialization procedure ...
1925 @}
1926
1927 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1928 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1929 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1930 @}
1931
1932 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1933
1934 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1935
1936 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1937 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1938 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1939 @}
1940 @end example
1941
1942 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1943 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1944
1945 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1946
1947 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1948 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1949
1950 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1951 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1952
1953 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1954 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1955 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1956 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1957 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1958 events already assigned.
1959
1960 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1961
1962 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1963 special high speed download features - enable it.
1964
1965 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1966
1967 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1968 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1969 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1970 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1971 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1972 If you are using an external trace port,
1973 configure it in your board config file.
1974 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1975 configure it in your target config file.
1976
1977 @example
1978 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1979 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1980 @end example
1981
1982 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1983
1984 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1985
1986 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1987 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1988 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1989 the TARGET (chip) file.
1990
1991 Examples:
1992 @itemize @bullet
1993 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1994 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1995 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1996 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1997 @end itemize
1998
1999 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
2000 @section Translating Configuration Files
2001 @cindex translation
2002 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2003 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2004 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2005 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2006 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2007 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2008
2009 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2010 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2011 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2012 convert other scripts later on.
2013
2014 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2015 replace job:
2016
2017 @example
2018 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2019 #
2020 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2021 #
2022 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2023 #
2024 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2025
2026 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2027 global TARGETNAME
2028
2029 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2030
2031 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2032 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2033 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2034 @}
2035 @end example
2036
2037
2038
2039 @node Server Configuration
2040 @chapter Server Configuration
2041 @cindex initialization
2042 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2043 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2044 supported.
2045
2046 @anchor{configurationstage}
2047 @section Configuration Stage
2048 @cindex configuration stage
2049 @cindex config command
2050
2051 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2052 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2053 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2054 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2055 inside startup scripts.
2056
2057 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2058 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2059 which may be issued interactively.
2060 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2061 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2062
2063 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2064 flash banks,
2065 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2066 and other basic setup.
2067 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2068 may access or activate TAPs.
2069 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2070 longer be issued.
2071
2072 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2073 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2074 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2075 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2076 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2077
2078 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2079 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2080 the command can be executed in either
2081 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2082 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2086 @section Entering the Run Stage
2087
2088 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2089 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2090 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2091 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2092 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2093 You should see no errors at this point.
2094 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2095 commands you used to configure the server.
2096 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2097 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2098 on the scan chain.
2099
2100 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2101 become available.
2102 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2103 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2104 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2105 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2106 entry to the run stage.
2107
2108 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2109 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2110 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2111 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2112 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2113 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2114 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2115
2116 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2117 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2118 configuration files and/or command line options.
2119
2120 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2121 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2122 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2123 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2124 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2125
2126 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2127 corresponding subsystems:
2128 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2129 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2130 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2131 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2132 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2133 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2134 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2135 @end deffn
2136
2137 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2138 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2139 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2140 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2141 @example
2142 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2143 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2144 @end example
2145 @end deffn
2146
2147 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2148 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2149 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2150 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2151 the run stage.
2152 @end deffn
2153
2154 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2155 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2156 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2157
2158 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2159 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2160 scan chain.
2161 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2162 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2163
2164 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2165 they return.
2166 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2167 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{tcpipports}
2171 @section TCP/IP Ports
2172 @cindex TCP port
2173 @cindex server
2174 @cindex port
2175 @cindex security
2176 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2177 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2178 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2179
2180 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2181 access using one or more of these ports.
2182 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2183 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2184 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2185
2186 You can request the operating system to select one of the available
2187 ports for the server by specifying the relevant port number as "0".
2188
2189 @anchor{gdb_port}
2190 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2191 @cindex GDB server
2192 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2193 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2194 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2195 the normal use cases.
2196
2197 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2198 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2199 disables the gdb server.
2200
2201 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2202 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2203
2204 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2205 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2206 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2207
2208 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2209 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2210 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2211 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2212 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2213 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2214 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2215 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2216 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2217
2218 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2219 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2220 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2224 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2225 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2226 output from the Tcl engine.
2227 Intended as a machine interface.
2228 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2229 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2230 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2234 Specify or query the
2235 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2236 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2237 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2238 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2239 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2240 @end deffn
2241
2242 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2243 @section GDB Configuration
2244 @cindex GDB
2245 @cindex GDB configuration
2246 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2247 The ones listed here are static and global.
2248 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2249 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2250
2251 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2252 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2253 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2254 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2255 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2256 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2257 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2258 @end deffn
2259
2260 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2261 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2262 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2263 vFlash packet is received.
2264 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2265 @end deffn
2266
2267 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2268 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2269 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2270 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2271 for flash programming to work.
2272 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2273 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2274 @end deffn
2275
2276 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2277 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2278 by GDB memory read packets.
2279 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2280 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2281 @end deffn
2282
2283 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2284 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2285 packets report errors or not.
2286 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2287 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2288 @end deffn
2289
2290 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2291 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2292 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2293 @end deffn
2294
2295 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2296 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2297
2298 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2299 @end deffn
2300
2301 @anchor{eventpolling}
2302 @section Event Polling
2303
2304 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2305 where significant events can happen at any time.
2306 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2307 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2308 or to GDB.
2309
2310 Examples of such events include:
2311
2312 @itemize
2313 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2314 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2315 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2316 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2317 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2318 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2319 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2320 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2321 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2322 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2323 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2324 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2325 @end itemize
2326
2327 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2328 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2329 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2330 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2331 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2332
2333 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2334 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2335 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2336 to the various active targets.
2337 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2338 which is normally done in the background.
2339
2340 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2341 Poll the current target for its current state.
2342 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2343 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2344 specific information about the current state is printed.
2345 An optional parameter
2346 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2347
2348 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2349 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2350 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2351 @example
2352 > poll
2353 background polling: on
2354 target state: halted
2355 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2356 current mode: Supervisor
2357 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2358 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2359 >
2360 @end example
2361 @end deffn
2362
2363 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2364 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2365 @cindex config file, interface
2366 @cindex interface config file
2367
2368 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2369 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2370 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2371
2372 @quotation Note
2373 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2374 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2375 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2376 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2377 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2378 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2379 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2380 @end quotation
2381
2382 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2383 through commands in an interface configuration
2384 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2385 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2386
2387 @example
2388 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2389 @end example
2390
2391 These commands tell
2392 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2393 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2394
2395 @example
2396 # jlink interface
2397 adapter driver jlink
2398 @end example
2399
2400 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2401
2402
2403 @section Adapter Configuration
2404
2405 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2406 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2407 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2408
2409 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2410 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2411 target.
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2415 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2416 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2417 @end deffn
2418 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2419 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2420 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2421 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2422 the hardware can support.
2423 @end deffn
2424
2425 @anchor{adapter gpio}
2426 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter gpio [ @
2427 @option{tdo} | @option{tdi} | @option{tms} | @option{tck} | @option{trst} | @
2428 @option{swdio} | @option{swdio_dir} | @option{swclk} | @option{srst} | @
2429 @option{led} @
2430 [ @
2431 gpio_number | @option{-chip} chip_number | @
2432 @option{-active-high} | @option{-active-low} | @
2433 @option{-push-pull} | @option{-open-drain} | @option{-open-source} | @
2434 @option{-pull-none} | @option{-pull-up} | @option{-pull-down} | @
2435 @option{-init-inactive} | @option{-init-active} | @option{-init-input} @
2436 ] ]}
2437
2438 Define the GPIO mapping that the adapter will use. The following signals can be
2439 defined:
2440
2441 @itemize @minus
2442 @item @option{tdo}, @option{tdi}, @option{tms}, @option{tck}, @option{trst}:
2443 JTAG transport signals
2444 @item @option{swdio}, @option{swclk}: SWD transport signals
2445 @item @option{swdio_dir}: optional swdio buffer control signal
2446 @item @option{srst}: system reset signal
2447 @item @option{led}: optional activity led
2448
2449 @end itemize
2450
2451 Some adapters require that the GPIO chip number is set in addition to the GPIO
2452 number. The configuration options enable signals to be defined as active-high or
2453 active-low. The output drive mode can be set to push-pull, open-drain or
2454 open-source. Most adapters will have to emulate open-drain or open-source drive
2455 modes by switching between an input and output. Input and output signals can be
2456 instructed to use a pull-up or pull-down resistor, assuming it is supported by
2457 the adaptor driver and hardware. The initial state of outputs may also be set,
2458 "active" state means 1 for active-high outputs and 0 for active-low outputs.
2459 Bidirectional signals may also be initialized as an input. If the swdio signal
2460 is buffered the buffer direction can be controlled with the swdio_dir signal;
2461 the active state means that the buffer should be set as an output with respect
2462 to the adapter. The command options are cumulative with later commands able to
2463 override settings defined by earlier ones. The two commands @command{gpio led 7
2464 -active-high} and @command{gpio led -chip 1 -active-low} sent sequentially are
2465 equivalent to issuing the single command @command{gpio led 7 -chip 1
2466 -active-low}. It is not permissible to set the drive mode or initial state for
2467 signals which are inputs. The drive mode for the srst and trst signals must be
2468 set with the @command{adapter reset_config} command. It is not permissible to
2469 set the initial state of swdio_dir as it is derived from the initial state of
2470 swdio. The command @command{adapter gpio} prints the current configuration for
2471 all GPIOs while the command @command{adapter gpio gpio_name} prints the current
2472 configuration for gpio_name. Not all adapters support this generic GPIO mapping,
2473 some require their own commands to define the GPIOs used. Adapters that support
2474 the generic mapping may not support all of the listed options.
2475 @end deffn
2476
2477 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2478 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2479 @end deffn
2480
2481 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2482 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2483 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2484 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2485 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2486 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2487
2488 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2489 @end deffn
2490
2491 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2492 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2493 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2494 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2495 arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, esp_usb_jtag, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2496 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2497 @end deffn
2498
2499 @section Interface Drivers
2500
2501 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2502 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2503 available at run time.
2504
2505 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2506 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2507 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2508 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2509
2510 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2511 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2512 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2516 Displays status of RTCK option.
2517 Optionally sets that option first.
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {angie}
2522 This is the NanoXplore's ANGIE USB-JTAG Adapter.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2526 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2527 This has one driver-specific command:
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2530 Logs some status
2531 @end deffn
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2535 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2536 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2537 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2538 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2539 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2543 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2544 or v2 (USB bulk).
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2547 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2548 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2549 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2550 @example
2551 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2552 @end example
2553 @end deffn
2554
2555 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2556 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2557
2558 @itemize @minus
2559 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2560 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2561 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2562 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2563 @end itemize
2564 @end deffn
2565
2566 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2567 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2568 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2569 interface string or for user class interface.
2570 @end deffn
2571
2572 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2573 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2577 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2578 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2579
2580 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2581 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2582 are logged.
2583 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2584 @end deffn
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2588 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2592 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2596 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2597 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2598
2599 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2600 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2601
2602 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2603 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2604
2605 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2606 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2607 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2608 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2609 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2610 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2611
2612 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2613 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2614 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2615 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2616 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2617
2618 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2619 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2620 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2621 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2622
2623 @itemize @minus
2624 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2625 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2626 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2627 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2628 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2629 switching data and direction as necessary
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2633 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2636 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2637 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2638 @example
2639 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2640 @end example
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2644 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2645 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2646 during device selection.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2650 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2651 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2655 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2656 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2657 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2658 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2659 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2660 and initially asserted reset signals.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2664 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2665 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2666 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2667 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2668 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2669 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2670 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2671 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2672 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2673 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2674
2675 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2676 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2677 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2678 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2679 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2680 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2681
2682 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2683 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2684 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2685 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2686 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2687 are always driven by the FTDI.
2688
2689 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2690 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2691 @var{name}.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2695 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2696 @itemize @minus
2697 @item @option{0}, drive low
2698 @item @option{1}, drive high
2699 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2700 @end itemize
2701 @end deffn
2702
2703 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2704 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2708 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2709
2710 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2711 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2712 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2713 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2714 @itemize @minus
2715 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2716 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2717 @end itemize
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2721 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2722
2723 @end deffn
2724
2725 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2726 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2727 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2728 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2729
2730 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2731 @itemize @minus
2732 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2733 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2734 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2735 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2736 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2737 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2738 @end itemize
2739
2740 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2741 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2742 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2743 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2744 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2745 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2746 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2747 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2748
2749 FT232R
2750 @itemize @minus
2751 @item bit 7 - RI
2752 @item bit 6 - DCD
2753 @item bit 5 - DSR
2754 @item bit 4 - DTR
2755 @item bit 3 - CTS
2756 @item bit 2 - RTS
2757 @item bit 1 - RXD
2758 @item bit 0 - TXD
2759 @end itemize
2760
2761 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2762 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2765 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2766 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2770 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2771 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2775 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2779 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2783 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2787 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2788 @end deffn
2789
2790 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2791 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2795 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2799 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2800 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2801 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2802 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2803 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2804 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2805 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2806 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2807 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2808 @end deffn
2809
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2813 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2814 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2815 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2816
2817 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2818 processors which are being simulated.
2819
2820 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2821 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2822 sockets instead of TCP.
2823 @end deffn
2824
2825 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2826 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2827 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2828 @end deffn
2829
2830 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2831 something like:
2832
2833 @example
2834 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2835 remote_bitbang port 3335
2836 remote_bitbang host foobar
2837 @end example
2838
2839 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2840 named mysocket:
2841
2842 @example
2843 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2844 remote_bitbang port 0
2845 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2846 @end example
2847 @end deffn
2848
2849 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2850 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2851 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2852 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2853
2854 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2855 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2856 default values are used.
2857 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2858 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2859 @example
2860 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2861 @end example
2862 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2863 @example
2864 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2865 @end example
2866 @end deffn
2867
2868 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2869 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2870 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2871 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2872 target board.
2873
2874 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2875 @example
2876 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2877 reset_config srst_only
2878 @end example
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2882 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2883 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2884 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2888 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2889 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @end deffn
2893
2894 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2895 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2896 This has one driver-specific command:
2897
2898 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2899 Display either the address of the I/O port
2900 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2901 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2902 This is a write-once setting.
2903 @end deffn
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2907 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2908 transports.
2909
2910 @quotation Compatibility Note
2911 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2912 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2913 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2914 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2915 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2916 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2917 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2918 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2919 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2920 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2921 @end quotation
2922
2923 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2924 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2925 states.
2926 @end deffn
2927 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2928 Display free device internal memory.
2929 @end deffn
2930 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2931 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2932 command version.
2933 @end deffn
2934 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2935 Display the device configuration.
2936 @end deffn
2937 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2938 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2939 power state.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2942 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2943 @end deffn
2944 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2945 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2946 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2947 IP configuration.
2948 @end deffn
2949 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2950 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2951 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2952 @end deffn
2953 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2954 Reset the current configuration.
2955 @end deffn
2956 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2957 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2958 @end deffn
2959 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2960 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2961 pairs.
2962
2963 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2964 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2965 @example
2966 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2967 @end example
2968 @end deffn
2969 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2970 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2971 pairs.
2972
2973 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2974 @example
2975 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2976 77a90000
2977 @end example
2978 @end deffn
2979 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2980 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2981 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2982 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2983 the serial number instead, if possible.
2984
2985 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2986 @end deffn
2987 @end deffn
2988
2989 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2990 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2991 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2992 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2993 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2994 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2995 configuration script.
2996
2997 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2998 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2999 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
3000 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
3001 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
3002
3003 Known limitations:
3004 @itemize @bullet
3005 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
3006 and 2.7 MHz.
3007 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
3008 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
3009 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
3010 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
3011 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
3012 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
3013 communications with the target.
3014 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
3015 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
3016 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
3017 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
3018 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
3019 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
3020 @end itemize
3021
3022 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
3023 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
3024 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
3028 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
3029 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
3030 target as a side-effect.
3031 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
3035 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
3036 version, and target voltage.
3037 @end deffn
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
3041 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
3042 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
3043 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
3044 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
3045
3046 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
3047 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
3048 This is a write-once setting.
3049 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
3050
3051 @itemize @minus
3052 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
3053 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
3054 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
3055 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
3056 in configuration mode. This is only used to
3057 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
3058 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
3059 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
3060 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
3061 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
3062 some versions of
3063 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3064 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3065 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3066 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3067 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3068 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3069 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3070 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3071 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3072 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3073 @end itemize
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3077 Display either the address of the I/O port
3078 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3079 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3080 This is a write-once setting.
3081
3082 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3083 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3084 you may encounter a problem.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3088 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3089 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3090 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3091 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3092 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3093
3094 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3095 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3096 @quotation Tip
3097 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3098 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3099 @example
3100 > parport toggling_time 1000
3101 > adapter speed 500
3102 @end example
3103 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3104 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3105 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3106 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3107 large set of samples.
3108 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3109 @example
3110 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3111 @end example
3112 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3113 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3114
3115 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3116 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3117 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3118 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3119 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3120 be conservative.
3121 @end quotation
3122 @end deffn
3123
3124 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3125 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3126 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3130 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3131
3132 @example
3133 adapter driver parport
3134 parport port 0x278
3135 parport cable wiggler
3136 @end example
3137 @end deffn
3138
3139 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3140 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3144 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3145 @end deffn
3146
3147 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3148 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3149 @end deffn
3150
3151 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3152 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3153
3154 @quotation Note
3155 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3156 which are not currently documented here.
3157 @end quotation
3158 @end deffn
3159
3160 @anchor{hla_interface}
3161 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3162 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3163 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3164 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3165
3166 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3167 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3168 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3169 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3170 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3171 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3172
3173 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3174 Currently Not Supported.
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3178 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3182 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3183 @end deffn
3184
3185 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3186 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3187 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3188
3189 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3190 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3191 ST-LINK server software module}.
3192 @end deffn
3193
3194 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3195 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3196 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3197 @end deffn
3198 @end deffn
3199
3200 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3201 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3202 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3203 (from firmware V2J24), STLINK-V3 and STLINK-V3PWR, thanks to a new API that provides
3204 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3205
3206 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3207 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3208 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3209 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3210
3211 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3212 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3213
3214 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3215 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3216 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3217
3218 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3219 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3220 ST-LINK server software module}.
3221
3222 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3226 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3230 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3231 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3232
3233 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3234 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3235 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3236 the target's supply voltage.
3237 @example
3238 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3239 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3240 @end example
3241 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3242 @example
3243 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3244 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3245 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3246 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3247 3.24891518738
3248 @end example
3249 @end deffn
3250 @end deffn
3251
3252 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3253 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3254 @end deffn
3255
3256 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3257 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3261 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3262 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3263 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3264 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3265
3266 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3267 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3268 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3269 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3270 @end deffn
3271
3272 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3273 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3274 version).
3275 @end deffn
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3279 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3280 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3281 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3282 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3283
3284 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3285
3286 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3287 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3288
3289 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3290 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3291
3292 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3293
3294 @end deffn
3295 @end deffn
3296
3297 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3298 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3299 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3300
3301 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3302 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3303 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3304 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3305 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3306 configuration on exit.
3307
3308 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons. GPIO configuration is
3309 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3310
3311 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3312 @file{interface/raspberrypi-gpio-connector.cfg} for pinout.
3313
3314 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3315 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3316 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_mem_dev} @var{device}
3320 Set the device path for access to the memory mapped GPIO control registers.
3321 Uses @file{/dev/gpiomem} by default, this is also the preferred option with
3322 respect to system security.
3323 If overridden to @file{/dev/mem}:
3324 @itemize @minus
3325 @item OpenOCD needs @code{cap_sys_rawio} or run as root to open @file{/dev/mem}.
3326 Please be aware of security issues imposed by running OpenOCD with
3327 elevated user rights and by @file{/dev/mem} itself.
3328 @item correct @command{peripheral_base} must be configured.
3329 @item GPIO 0-27 pads are set to the limited slew rate
3330 and drive strength is reduced to 4 mA (2 mA on RPi 4).
3331 @end itemize
3332
3333 @end deffn
3334
3335 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3336 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs.
3337 Ignored if @file{/dev/gpiomem} is used. For the RPi1, use
3338 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3339 list can be found in the
3340 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3341 @end deffn
3342
3343 @end deffn
3344
3345 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3346 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3347 of the one which is most popular.
3348
3349 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3350
3351 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3352 pinout.
3353
3354 @end deffn
3355
3356
3357 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3358 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3359 on the two expansion headers.
3360
3361 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3362 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3363 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3364 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3365
3366 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIO configuration is handled by the generic
3367 command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3368
3369 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3370 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3371 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3372 @end deffn
3373
3374 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3375
3376 @end deffn
3377
3378
3379 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3380 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel
3381 version v4.6. The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through
3382 bitbanging. There are no driver-specific commands, all GPIO configuration is
3383 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}. This
3384 driver supports the resistor pull options provided by the @command{adapter gpio}
3385 command but the underlying hardware may not be able to support them.
3386
3387 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390
3391 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3392 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3393 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3394
3395 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398
3399 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3400 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3401 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3402
3403 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3404 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3405 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3406
3407 @itemize @minus
3408 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3409 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3410 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3411 @end itemize
3412 @end deffn
3413
3414 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3415 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3416 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3417 @end deffn
3418 @end deffn
3419
3420
3421 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3422 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3423
3424 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3425 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3426 @end deffn
3427
3428 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3429 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3430 0 for no batching
3431 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3432 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3433 @end deffn
3434
3435 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3436 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3437 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3438 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3439 timeout value.
3440 @end deffn
3441
3442 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3443 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3444 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3445 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3446 @end deffn
3447
3448 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3449 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3450 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3451 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3452 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3453 @end deffn
3454 @end deffn
3455
3456 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3457 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3458 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3459 DPI server interface.
3460
3461 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3462 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3463 @end deffn
3464
3465 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3466 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3467 @end deffn
3468 @end deffn
3469
3470
3471 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3472
3473 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3474 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3475
3476 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3477 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3478
3479 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3480 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3481 @example
3482 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3483 @end example
3484 @end deffn
3485
3486 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3487 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3488 @example
3489 buspirate speed normal
3490 @end example
3491 @end deffn
3492
3493 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3494 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3495 @itemize @minus
3496 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3497 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3498 @end itemize
3499 For example:
3500 @example
3501 buspirate mode normal
3502 @end example
3503 @end deffn
3504
3505 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3506 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3507 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3508 For example:
3509 @example
3510 buspirate pullup 0
3511 @end example
3512 @end deffn
3513
3514 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3515 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3516 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3517 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3518 @example
3519 buspirate vreg 0
3520 @end example
3521 @end deffn
3522
3523 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3524 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3525 @end deffn
3526 @example
3527 buspirate led 1
3528 @end example
3529
3530 @end deffn
3531
3532 @deffn {Interface Driver} {esp_usb_jtag}
3533 Espressif JTAG driver to communicate with ESP32-C3, ESP32-S3 chips and ESP USB Bridge board using OpenOCD.
3534 These chips have built-in JTAG circuitry and can be debugged without any additional hardware.
3535 Only an USB cable connected to the D+/D- pins is necessary.
3536
3537 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag tdo}
3538 Returns the current state of the TDO line
3539 @end deffn
3540
3541 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag setio} setio
3542 Manually set the status of the output lines with the order of (tdi tms tck trst srst)
3543 @example
3544 espusbjtag setio 0 1 0 1 0
3545 @end example
3546 @end deffn
3547
3548 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag vid_pid} vid_pid
3549 Set vendor ID and product ID for the ESP usb jtag driver
3550 @example
3551 espusbjtag vid_pid 0x303a 0x1001
3552 @end example
3553 @end deffn
3554
3555 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag caps_descriptor} caps_descriptor
3556 Set the jtag descriptor to read capabilities of ESP usb jtag driver
3557 @example
3558 espusbjtag caps_descriptor 0x2000
3559 @end example
3560 @end deffn
3561
3562 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag chip_id} chip_id
3563 Set chip id to transfer to the ESP USB bridge board
3564 @example
3565 espusbjtag chip_id 1
3566 @end example
3567 @end deffn
3568
3569 @end deffn
3570
3571 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dmem} Direct Memory access debug interface
3572
3573 The Texas Instruments K3 SoC family provides memory access to DAP
3574 and coresight control registers. This allows control over the
3575 microcontrollers directly from one of the processors on the SOC
3576 itself.
3577
3578 For maximum performance, the driver accesses the debug registers
3579 directly over the SoC memory map. The memory mapping requires read
3580 and write permission to kernel memory via "/dev/mem" and assumes that
3581 the system firewall configurations permit direct access to the debug
3582 memory space.
3583
3584 @verbatim
3585 +-----------+
3586 | OpenOCD | SoC mem map (/dev/mem)
3587 | on +--------------+
3588 | Cortex-A53| |
3589 +-----------+ |
3590 |
3591 +-----------+ +-----v-----+
3592 |Cortex-M4F <--------+ |
3593 +-----------+ | |
3594 | DebugSS |
3595 +-----------+ | |
3596 |Cortex-M4F <--------+ |
3597 +-----------+ +-----------+
3598 @end verbatim
3599
3600 NOTE: Firewalls are configurable in K3 SoC and depending on various types of
3601 device configuration, this function may be blocked out. Typical behavior
3602 observed in such cases is a firewall exception report on the security
3603 controller and armv8 processor reporting a system error.
3604
3605 See @file{tcl/interface/ti_k3_am625-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration
3606 file.
3607
3608 @deffn {Command} {dmem info}
3609 Print the DAPBUS dmem configuration.
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem device} device_path
3613 Set the DAPBUS memory access device (default: /dev/mem).
3614 @end deffn
3615
3616 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem base_address} base_address
3617 Set the DAPBUS base address which is used to access CoreSight
3618 compliant Access Ports (APs) directly.
3619 @end deffn
3620
3621 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem ap_address_offset} offset_address
3622 Set the address offset between Access Ports (APs).
3623 @end deffn
3624
3625 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem max_aps} n
3626 Set the maximum number of valid access ports on the SoC.
3627 @end deffn
3628
3629 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem emu_ap_list} n
3630 Set the list of Access Ports (APs) that need to be emulated. This
3631 emulation mode supports software translation of an AP request into an
3632 address mapped transaction that does not rely on physical AP hardware.
3633 This maybe needed if the AP is either denied access via memory map or
3634 protected using other SoC mechanisms.
3635 @end deffn
3636
3637 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem emu_base_address_range} base_address address_window_size
3638 Set the emulated address and address window size. Both of these
3639 parameters must be aligned to page size.
3640 @end deffn
3641
3642 @end deffn
3643
3644 @section Transport Configuration
3645 @cindex Transport
3646 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3647 and the debug adapter you are using,
3648 several transports may be available to
3649 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3650 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3651 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3652 version of OpenOCD.
3653 @end deffn
3654
3655 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3656 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3657
3658 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3659 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3660 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3661 adapter's driver).
3662
3663 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3664 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3665 supported by the debug adapter.
3666
3667 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3668 transport, if any.
3669 @end deffn
3670
3671 @subsection JTAG Transport
3672 @cindex JTAG
3673 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3674 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3675 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3676 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3677 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3678 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3679
3680 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3681 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3682 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3683 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3684 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3685
3686 @subsection SWD Transport
3687 @cindex SWD
3688 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3689 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3690 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3691 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3692 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3693 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3694 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3695
3696 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3697 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3698 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3699 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3700 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3701
3702 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3703 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3704 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3705 expected to change.
3706 @end deffn
3707
3708 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3709 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3710 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3711 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3712 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3713 DAPs are created.
3714
3715 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3716 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3717 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3718
3719 @subsection SPI Transport
3720 @cindex SPI
3721 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3722 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3723 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3724 solution for flash programming.
3725
3726 @anchor{swimtransport}
3727 @subsection SWIM Transport
3728 @cindex SWIM
3729 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3730 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3731 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3732 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3733
3734 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3735
3736 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3737
3738 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3739 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3740 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3741 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3742 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3743
3744 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3745 @section JTAG Speed
3746 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3747 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3748 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3749 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3750 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3751 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3752 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3753 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3754 power management software that may be active.
3755
3756 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3757 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3758 target event handler.
3759 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3760 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3761 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3762 sets up those clocks).
3763 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3764 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3765 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3766 in the target config file.
3767 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3768 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3769 config file instead.
3770 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3771 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3772 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3773
3774 @example
3775 jtag_rclk 3000
3776 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3777 @end example
3778
3779 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3780 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3781 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3782 may not be the fastest solution.
3783
3784 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3785 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3786 which support adaptive clocking.
3787
3788 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3789 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3790 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3791 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3792 than the speed specified.
3793
3794 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3795 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3796 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3797 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3798
3799 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3800 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3801 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3802 JTAG clocking after setup.
3803 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3804 If the interface device can not
3805 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3806 @end deffn
3807
3808 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3809 @cindex adaptive clocking
3810 @cindex RTCK
3811 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3812 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3813 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3814 @example
3815 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3816 jtag_rclk 3000
3817 @end example
3818 @end defun
3819
3820 @node Reset Configuration
3821 @chapter Reset Configuration
3822 @cindex Reset Configuration
3823
3824 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3825 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3826 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3827 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3828 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3829 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3830 Please see the various board files for examples.
3831
3832 @quotation Note
3833 To maintainers and integrators:
3834 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3835 Normally the board configuration file
3836 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3837 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3838
3839 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3840 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3841 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3842 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3843 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3844 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3845 @end quotation
3846
3847 @section Types of Reset
3848
3849 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3850 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3851 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3852
3853 @itemize @bullet
3854 @item
3855 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3856 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3857 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3858 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3859 @item
3860 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3861 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3862 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3863 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3864 @item
3865 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3866 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3867 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3868 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3869 @item
3870 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3871 several other types of reset.
3872 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3873 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3874 There may be individual module resets.
3875 @end itemize
3876
3877 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3878 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3879 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3880 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3881 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3882 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3883 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3884 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3885 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3886
3887 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3888 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3889
3890 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3891 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3892 common issues are:
3893
3894 @itemize @bullet
3895
3896 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3897 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3898 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3899 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3900 when either of those signals is not connected.
3901 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3902 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3903 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3904 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3905
3906 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3907 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3908 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3909 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3910
3911 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3912 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3913 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3914 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3915 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3916 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3917 hardware debouncing.
3918 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3919 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3920
3921 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3922 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3923 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3924 to use push/pull output drivers.
3925 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3926 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3927 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3928 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3929
3930 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3931 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3932 issues (not limited to errata).
3933 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3934 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3935 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3936 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3937 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3938 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3939 @end itemize
3940
3941 There can also be other issues.
3942 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3943 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3944 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3945 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3946 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3947 Agreement (NDA).
3948
3949 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3950 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3951 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3952
3953 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3954 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3955
3956 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3957
3958 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3959 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3960 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3961 allowing it to be deasserted.
3962 @end deffn
3963
3964 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3965 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3966 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3967 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3968 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3969 @end deffn
3970
3971 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3972 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3973 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3974 allowing it to be deasserted.
3975 @end deffn
3976
3977 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3978 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3979 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3980 @end deffn
3981
3982 @anchor{reset_config}
3983 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3984 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3985 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3986 configuration scripts.
3987
3988 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3989 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3990 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3991 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3992 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3993 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3994 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3995 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3996
3997 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3998 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3999 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
4000 -- may be specified at a time.
4001 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
4002 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
4003 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
4004 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
4005 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
4006
4007 @itemize
4008 @item
4009 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
4010 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
4011 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
4012 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
4013 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
4014
4015 @quotation Tip
4016 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
4017 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
4018 @end quotation
4019
4020 @item
4021 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
4022 signal implementations.
4023 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
4024 indicating everything behaves normally.
4025 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
4026 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
4027 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
4028 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
4029 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
4030 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
4031 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
4032
4033 @item
4034 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4035 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
4036 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
4037 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
4038 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
4039 while SRST is asserted.
4040 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
4041 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
4042
4043 @item
4044 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4045 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
4046 is required to use this option.
4047 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
4048 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
4049 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
4050 be asserted before any target connection.
4051 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
4052 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
4053 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
4054 @end itemize
4055
4056 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
4057 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
4058 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
4059 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
4060 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
4061
4062 @itemize
4063 @item
4064 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
4065 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
4066 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
4067 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
4068
4069 @item
4070 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
4071 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
4072 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
4073 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
4074 power-up and pressing a reset button.
4075 @end itemize
4076 @end deffn
4077
4078 @section Custom Reset Handling
4079 @cindex events
4080
4081 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
4082 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
4083 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
4084 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
4085 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
4086 at particular points in the reset sequence.
4087
4088 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4089 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4090 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4091 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4092 want to reset everything at once.
4093
4094 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4095 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4096 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4097 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4098 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4099 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4100 needs special attention.
4101
4102 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4103 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4104 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4105 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4106 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4107 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4108 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4109 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4110 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4111
4112 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4113 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4114 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4115 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4116 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4117
4118 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4119 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4120 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4121 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4122 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4123 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4124 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4125 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4126 or potentially some other value.
4127
4128 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4129 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4130 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4131 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4132 (or their associated targets)
4133 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4134
4135 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4136 they return.
4137 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4138 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4139 @end deffn
4140
4141 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4142 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4143 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4144 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4145 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4146 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4147 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4148 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4149 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4150 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4151 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4152 @end deffn
4153
4154 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4155 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4156 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4157 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4158 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4159 @end deffn
4160
4161
4162 @node TAP Declaration
4163 @chapter TAP Declaration
4164 @cindex TAP declaration
4165 @cindex TAP configuration
4166
4167 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4168 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4169
4170 @itemize @bullet
4171 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4172 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4173 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4174 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4175 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4176 start running that code.
4177 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4178 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4179 and missing connections.
4180 @end itemize
4181
4182 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4183 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4184 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4185 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4186 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4187
4188 @section Scan Chains
4189 @cindex scan chain
4190
4191 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4192 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4193 They also need to be added to
4194 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4195 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4196 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4197 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4198 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4199 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4200 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4201 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4202
4203 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4204 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4205 command, presented in the next chapter.
4206 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4207 debugging targets.)
4208 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4209
4210 @verbatim
4211 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4212 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4213 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4214 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4215 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4216 @end verbatim
4217
4218 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4219 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4220 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4221 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4222 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4223 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4224 until they are told to do so.
4225
4226 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4227 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4228 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4229 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4230
4231 @example
4232 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4233 @end example
4234
4235 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4236 by a given chip.
4237 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4238 and so forth.
4239 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4240 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4241 both inside a single chip and between them.
4242 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4243
4244 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4245 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4246 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4247 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4248 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4249 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4250 includes commands something like this:
4251
4252 @example
4253 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4254 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4255 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4256 @end example
4257
4258 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4259 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4260 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4261
4262 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4263 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4264 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4265 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4266 @example
4267 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4268 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4269 @}
4270 @end example
4271 @end deffn
4272
4273 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4274 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4275 and their status.
4276 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4277 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4278 but systems with a JTAG router can
4279 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4280 @end deffn
4281
4282 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4283 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4284
4285 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4286 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4287
4288 @section TAP Names
4289 @cindex dotted name
4290
4291 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4292 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4293 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4294 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4295 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4296 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4297 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4298 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4299
4300 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4301 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4302 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4303
4304 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4305
4306 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4307 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4308 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4309
4310 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4311 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4312 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4313 overridable.
4314
4315 @cindex TAP naming convention
4316 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4317 and should follow this convention:
4318
4319 @itemize @bullet
4320 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4321 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4322 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4323 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4324 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4325 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4326 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4327 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4328 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4329 with a single TAP;
4330 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4331 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4332 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4333 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4334 @end itemize
4335
4336 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4337
4338 @itemize @bullet
4339 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4340 @*The length in bits of the
4341 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4342 @end itemize
4343
4344 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4345
4346 @itemize @bullet
4347 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4348 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4349 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4350 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4351 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4352 (the TAP is linked in).
4353 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4354 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4355 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4356 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4357 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4358 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4359 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4360 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4361 values that were found but not included in the list.
4362
4363 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4364 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4365 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4366 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4367 hardware to find these values.
4368 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4369 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4370 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4371 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4372 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4373 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4374 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4375 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4376 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4377 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4378 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4379 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4380 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4381 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4382 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4383 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4384 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4385 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4386 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4387 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4388 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4389 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4390 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4391 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4392 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4393 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4394 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4395 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4396 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4397 @end itemize
4398 @end deffn
4399
4400 @section Other TAP commands
4401
4402 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4403 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4404 @end deffn
4405
4406 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4407 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4408 At this writing this TAP attribute
4409 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4410 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4411 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4412 See the next section for information about the available events.
4413
4414 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4415 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4416 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4417 @end deffn
4418
4419 @section TAP Events
4420 @cindex events
4421 @cindex TAP events
4422
4423 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4424 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4425 The other applies to debugger targets,
4426 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4427
4428 The TAP events currently defined are:
4429
4430 @itemize @bullet
4431 @item @b{post-reset}
4432 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4433 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4434 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4435 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4436 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4437
4438 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4439 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4440 of any particular target.
4441 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4442 @item @b{setup}
4443 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4444 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4445 @item @b{tap-disable}
4446 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4447 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4448 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4449 @item @b{tap-enable}
4450 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4451 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4452 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4453 @end itemize
4454
4455 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4456 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4457 contents to be accurate), you might:
4458
4459 @example
4460 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4461 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4462 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4463 @}
4464 @end example
4465
4466
4467 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4468 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4469 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4470 @cindex jrc
4471
4472 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4473 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4474 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4475 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4476 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4477
4478 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4479 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4480 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4481 be visible.
4482 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4483 ignores, such as:
4484
4485 @itemize
4486 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4487 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4488 TAPs receive new instructions.
4489 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4490 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4491 @end itemize
4492
4493 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4494 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4495 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4496 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4497
4498 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4499 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4500
4501 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4502 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4503 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4504 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4505 should define TAP event handlers using
4506 code that looks something like this:
4507
4508 @example
4509 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4510 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4511 @}
4512 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4513 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4514 @}
4515 @end example
4516
4517 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4518
4519 @example
4520 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4521 @end example
4522
4523 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4524 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4525 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4526 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4527
4528 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4529 If necessary, disables the tap
4530 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4531 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4532 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4533 and "0" if it is disabled.
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4537 If necessary, enables the tap
4538 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4539 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4540 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4541 and "0" if it is disabled.
4542 @end deffn
4543
4544 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4545 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4546 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4547 and "0" if it is disabled.
4548
4549 @quotation Note
4550 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4551 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4552 @end quotation
4553 @end deffn
4554
4555 @anchor{autoprobing}
4556 @section Autoprobing
4557 @cindex autoprobe
4558 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4559
4560 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4561 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4562 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4563 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4564
4565 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4566 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4567 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4568 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4569 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4570 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4571 right when they come out of reset).
4572
4573 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4574
4575 @example
4576 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4577 reset_config trst_and_srst
4578 jtag_rclk 8
4579 @end example
4580
4581 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4582 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4583
4584 @enumerate
4585 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4586 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4587 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4588 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4589 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4590 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4591 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4592 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4593 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4594 that is discovered.
4595 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4596 register, it will report it.
4597 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4598 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4599 @end enumerate
4600
4601 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4602 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4603 that's a bit more complex:
4604
4605 @example
4606 clock speed 8 kHz
4607 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4608 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4609 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4610 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4611 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4612 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4613 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4614 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4615 @end example
4616
4617 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4618 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4619 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4620 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4621 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4622 and so forth.
4623
4624 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4625 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4626 @cindex DAP declaration
4627
4628 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4629 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4630 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4631 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4632 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4633
4634 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4635
4636 @anchor{dap_create}
4637 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4638 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4639 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4640 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4641 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4642
4643 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4644
4645 @itemize @bullet
4646 @item @code{-adiv5}
4647 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4648 @item @code{-adiv6}
4649 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4650 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4651 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4652 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4653 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4654 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4655
4656 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4657 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4658 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4659 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4660 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4661 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4662
4663 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4664 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4665 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4666 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4667 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4668 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4669 @end itemize
4670 @end deffn
4671
4672 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4673 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4674 for TCL scripting.
4675 @end deffn
4676
4677 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4678 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4679 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4680 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4681 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4682 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4683 @end deffn
4684
4685 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4686 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4687 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4688 initialization, too.
4689 @end deffn
4690
4691 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4692
4693 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4694 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4695 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4696 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4697 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4698 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4699 @end deffn
4700
4701 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4702 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4703 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4704 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4705 @end deffn
4706
4707 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4708 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4709 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4710 or set a new value @var{value}.
4711 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4712 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
4713 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4714 @end deffn
4715
4716 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4717 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4718 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4719 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4720 @end deffn
4721
4722 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4723 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4724 value @var{value}.
4725
4726 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4727 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4728 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4729
4730 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4731 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4732 @end deffn
4733
4734 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4735 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4736 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4737 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4738 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4739 @end deffn
4740
4741 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4742 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4743 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4744 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4745 @end deffn
4746
4747 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4748 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4749
4750 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4751 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4752 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4753 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4754 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4755 for details.
4756
4757 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4758 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4759 the pattern:
4760 @example
4761 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4762 @end example
4763
4764 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4765 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4766 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4767 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4768 @example
4769 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4770 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4771 @end example
4772
4773 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4774 @example
4775 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4776 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4777 @end example
4778
4779 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4780 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4781
4782 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4783 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4784 example with a proper dap name:
4785 @example
4786 xxx.dap apcsw default
4787 @end example
4788 @end deffn
4789
4790 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4791 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4792 Disabled by default
4793 @end deffn
4794
4795 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name nu_npcx_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4796 Set/get quirks mode for Nuvoton NPCX/NPCD MCU families
4797 Disabled by default
4798 @end deffn
4799
4800 @node CPU Configuration
4801 @chapter CPU Configuration
4802 @cindex GDB target
4803
4804 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4805 You can also access these targets without GDB
4806 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4807 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4808 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4809 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4810
4811 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4812 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4813
4814 @section Target List
4815 @cindex target, current
4816 @cindex target, list
4817
4818 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4819 where each member has a name.
4820 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4821 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4822 (plural!) command.
4823 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4824 look like with more than one:
4825 @verbatim
4826 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4827 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4828 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4829 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4830 @end verbatim
4831
4832 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4833 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4834 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4835 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4836 space seen by that current target.
4837 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4838 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4839 are examples; and there are many more.
4840
4841 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4842
4843 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4844 Returns the name of the current target.
4845 @end deffn
4846
4847 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4848 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4849 @example
4850 foreach t [target names] @{
4851 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4852 @}
4853 @end example
4854 @end deffn
4855
4856 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4857 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4858
4859 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4860 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4861 command names are singular.}
4862
4863 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4864 targets in a user friendly form.
4865
4866 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4867 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4868 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4869 @end deffn
4870
4871 @section Target CPU Types
4872 @cindex target type
4873 @cindex CPU type
4874
4875 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4876 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4877 when calling @command{target create}.
4878 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4879 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4880 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4881 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4882 what core-specific commands may be available
4883 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4884 and more.
4885
4886 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4887 since there's a command to list them.
4888
4889 @anchor{targettypes}
4890 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4891 Lists all supported target types.
4892 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4893
4894 @itemize @bullet
4895 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4896 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4897 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4898 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4899 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4900 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4901 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4902 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4903 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4904 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4905 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4906 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4907 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4908 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4909 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4910 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4911 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4912 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4913 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4914 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4915 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4916 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4917 @item @code{esp32} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4918 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4919 @item @code{esp32s3} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4920 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4921 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4922 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4923 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4924 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4925 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4926 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4927 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4928 support for new CPUs.
4929 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4930 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4931 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4932 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4933 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4934 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4935 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4936 @itemize @minus
4937 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4938 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4939 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4940 @end itemize
4941 And two debug interfaces cores:
4942 @itemize @minus
4943 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4944 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4945 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4946 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4947 @end itemize
4948 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4949 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4950 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4951 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4952 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4953 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4954 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4955 @item @code{xtensa} -- this is a generic Cadence/Tensilica Xtensa core.
4956 @end itemize
4957 @end deffn
4958
4959 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4960 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4961 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4962 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4963 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4964 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4965 reflect design generations;
4966 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4967 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4968
4969 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4970 @section Target Configuration
4971
4972 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4973 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4974 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4975 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4976 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4977
4978 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4979 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4980 optional parts.
4981 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4982 command, created as part of target creation.
4983
4984 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4985 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4986 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4987 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4988 to be much more board-specific.
4989 The key steps you use might look something like this
4990
4991 @example
4992 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4993 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4994 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4995 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4996 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4997 @end example
4998
4999 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
5000 on-chip SRAM.
5001 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
5002 writes to target memory;
5003 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
5004 GDB memory checksumming;
5005 and more.
5006
5007 @quotation Warning
5008 On more complex chips, the work area can become
5009 inaccessible when application code
5010 (such as an operating system)
5011 enables or disables the MMU.
5012 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
5013 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
5014 easy access to other addresses needed.
5015 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
5016 @end quotation
5017
5018 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
5019 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
5020 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
5021 controllers.
5022 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
5023 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
5024 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
5025
5026 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
5027 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
5028 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
5029 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
5030 purposes including additional configuration.
5031
5032 @itemize @bullet
5033 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
5034 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
5035 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
5036 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
5037
5038 This name is also used to create the target object command,
5039 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
5040 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
5041 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
5042 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
5043 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
5044 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
5045
5046 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
5047 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
5048 @end itemize
5049 @end deffn
5050
5051 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
5052 The options accepted by this command may also be
5053 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
5054 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
5055 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
5056
5057 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
5058 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
5059 and changing its endianness.
5060
5061 @itemize @bullet
5062
5063 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
5064 used to access this target.
5065
5066 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
5067 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
5068 create and manage DAP instances.
5069
5070 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
5071 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
5072
5073 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
5074 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5075 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
5076 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
5077 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
5078 same event name assigns only one handler.
5079
5080 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
5081 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
5082
5083 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
5084 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
5085 @emph{it is not backed up.}
5086 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
5087 since performing a backup slows down operations.
5088 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
5089 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
5090
5091 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
5092 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
5093 or virtual address is being used.
5094
5095 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
5096 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5097
5098 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5099 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5100 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5101 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5102 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5103
5104 @anchor{rtostype}
5105 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5106 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{none}, @option{eCos},
5107 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5108 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5109 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}, @option{rtkernel}
5110 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5111
5112 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5113 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5114 access the target for debugging.
5115
5116 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
5117 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5118 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5119 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5120 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5121
5122 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5123 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5124 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5125 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5126 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5127
5128 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5129 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5130 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5131 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5132 command @command{gdb_port}.
5133 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5134
5135 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5136 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5137 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5138 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5139 @end itemize
5140 @end deffn
5141
5142 @section Other $target_name Commands
5143 @cindex object command
5144
5145 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5146 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5147
5148 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5149 Once a button is created a button
5150 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5151 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5152 configure it like this:
5153
5154 @example
5155 # Create
5156 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5157 # Modify
5158 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5159 # Query
5160 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5161 # Report
5162 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5163 @end example
5164
5165 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5166 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5167
5168 @example
5169 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5170 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5171 @end example
5172
5173 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5174
5175 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5176 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5177 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5178 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5179 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5180 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5181 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5182 They are not otherwise documented here.
5183 @end deffn
5184
5185 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5186 Set register values of the target.
5187
5188 @itemize
5189 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5190 @end itemize
5191
5192 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5193 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5194
5195 @example
5196 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5197 @end example
5198 @end deffn
5199
5200 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5201 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5202 of register names and values.
5203 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5204 target, bypassing any caching.
5205
5206 @itemize
5207 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5208 @end itemize
5209
5210 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5211 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5212
5213 @example
5214 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5215 @end example
5216 @end deffn
5217
5218 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5219 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5220 script.
5221
5222 @itemize
5223 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5224 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5225 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5226 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5227 @end itemize
5228
5229 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5230 memory at address 0x20000000:
5231
5232 @example
5233 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5234 @end example
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5238 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5239 script.
5240 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5241
5242 @itemize
5243 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5244 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5245 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5246 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5247 @end itemize
5248
5249 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5250 memory at address 0x20000000:
5251
5252 @example
5253 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5254 @end example
5255 @end deffn
5256
5257 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5258 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5259 @command{$target_name configure}
5260 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5261 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5262 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5263 There are a few special cases:
5264
5265 @itemize @bullet
5266 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5267 event named @var{event_name}.
5268 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5269 two parameters.
5270 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5271 This is a special case because this is set using
5272 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5273 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5274 @end itemize
5275
5276 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5277 all the targets you might use something like this:
5278
5279 @example
5280 foreach name [target names] @{
5281 set y [$name cget -endian]
5282 set z [$name cget -type]
5283 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5284 $x $name $y $z]
5285 @}
5286 @end example
5287 @end deffn
5288
5289 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5290 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5291 Displays the current target state:
5292 @code{debug-running},
5293 @code{halted},
5294 @code{reset},
5295 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5296 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5297 @end deffn
5298
5299 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5300 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5301 currently associated with this target.
5302 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5303 @end deffn
5304
5305 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5306 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5307 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5308 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5309 @end deffn
5310
5311 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5312 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5313 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5314 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5315 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5316 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5317 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5318 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5319 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5320 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5321 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5322 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5323 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5324 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5325 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5326 @end deffn
5327
5328 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5329 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5330 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5331 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5332 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5333 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5334 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5335 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5336 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5337 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5338 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5339 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5340 @end deffn
5341
5342 @anchor{targetevents}
5343 @section Target Events
5344 @cindex target events
5345 @cindex events
5346 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5347 For example:
5348 @itemize @bullet
5349 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5350 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5351 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5352 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5353 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5354 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5355 to set up system clocks or
5356 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5357 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5358 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5359 @end itemize
5360
5361 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5362 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5363 @command{target create ... -event}.
5364
5365 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5366 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5367 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5368
5369 @example
5370 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5371 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5372 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5373 @}
5374 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5375 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5376 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5377 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5378 @}
5379 @end example
5380
5381 The following target events are defined:
5382
5383 @itemize @bullet
5384 @item @b{debug-halted}
5385 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5386 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5387 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5388 @item @b{early-halted}
5389 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5390 @item @b{examine-start}
5391 @* Before target examine is called.
5392 @item @b{examine-end}
5393 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5394 @item @b{examine-fail}
5395 @* After target examine fails.
5396 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5397 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5398 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5399 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5400 connect GDB to running target.
5401 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5402 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5403 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5404 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5405 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5406 is in RAM or read only memory.
5407 Default is @code{halt}
5408 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5409 @* When GDB disconnects
5410 @item @b{gdb-end}
5411 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5412 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5413 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5414 @code{reset init})
5415 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5416 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5417 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5418 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5419 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5420 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5421 @item @b{gdb-start}
5422 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5423 @item @b{halted}
5424 @* The target has halted
5425 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5426 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5427 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5428 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5429 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5430 @item @b{reset-assert}
5431 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5432 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5433 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5434 it instead of asserting SRST.
5435 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5436 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5437 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5438 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5439 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5440 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5441 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5442 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5443 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5444 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5445 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5446 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5447 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5448 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5449 released on the scan chain.
5450 @item @b{reset-end}
5451 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5452 @item @b{reset-init}
5453 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5454 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5455
5456 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5457 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5458 multiplexing, and so on.
5459 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5460 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5461 @item @b{reset-start}
5462 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5463 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5464
5465 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5466 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5467 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5468 @item @b{resume-start}
5469 @* Before any target is resumed
5470 @item @b{resume-end}
5471 @* After all targets have resumed
5472 @item @b{resumed}
5473 @* Target has resumed
5474 @item @b{step-start}
5475 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5476 @item @b{step-end}
5477 @* After single-step has completed
5478 @item @b{trace-config}
5479 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5480 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5481 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5482 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5483 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5484 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5485 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5486 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5487 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5488 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5489 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5490 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5491 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5492 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5493 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5494 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5495 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5496 @end itemize
5497
5498 @quotation Note
5499 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5500 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5501 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5502 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5503 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5504 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5505 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5506 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5507 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5508 check if the core has changed status.
5509 @end quotation
5510
5511 @node Flash Commands
5512 @chapter Flash Commands
5513
5514 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5515 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5516 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5517 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5518 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5519 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5520 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5521 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5522 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5523
5524 Flash Steps:
5525 @enumerate
5526 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5527 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5528 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5529 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5530 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5531 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5532 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5533 @item GDB Flashing
5534 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5535 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5536 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5537 @end enumerate
5538
5539 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5540 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5541 so that it can't boot.
5542 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5543 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5544
5545 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5546 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5547 @cindex flash configuration
5548
5549 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5550 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5551 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5552 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5553 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5554 see the driver-specific documentation.
5555
5556 @itemize @bullet
5557 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5558 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5559 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5560 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5561 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5562 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5563 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5564 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5565 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5566 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5567 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5568 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5569 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5570 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5571 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5572 commands to the flash controller.
5573 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5574 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5575 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5576 for more information.
5577 @end itemize
5578 @quotation Note
5579 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5580 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5581 @end quotation
5582 @end deffn
5583
5584 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5585 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5586 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5587 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5588 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5589 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5590 @end deffn
5591
5592 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5593 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5594 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5595 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5596 @end deffn
5597
5598 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5599 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5600 depends on the flash type.
5601 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5602 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5603 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5604 but most don't bother.
5605 @end deffn
5606
5607 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5608
5609 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5610 begins.
5611
5612 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5613 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5614 until the programming session is finished.
5615
5616 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5617 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5618
5619 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5620
5621 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5622 @cindex flash erasing
5623 @cindex flash reading
5624 @cindex flash writing
5625 @cindex flash programming
5626 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5627
5628 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5629 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5630 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5631 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5632 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5633
5634 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5635 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5636 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5637 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5638 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5639
5640 @quotation Note
5641 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5642 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5643 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5644 back to a flash bank.
5645 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5646 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5647 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5648 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5649 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5650 @end quotation
5651
5652 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5653 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5654 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5655 disabled first.
5656 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5657 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5658 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5659
5660 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5661 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5662 up to and including @var{last}.
5663 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5664 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5665 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5666 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5667 @end deffn
5668
5669 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5670 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5671 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5672 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5673 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5674 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5675 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5676 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5677 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5678 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5679 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5680 before erase starts.
5681 @end deffn
5682
5683 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5684 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5685 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5686 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5687 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5688 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5689 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5690 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5691 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5692 before issuing this command.
5693 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5694 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5695 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5696 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5697 @end deffn
5698 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5699
5700 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5701 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5702 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5703 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5704 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5705 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5706 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5707 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5708 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5709 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5710 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5711 @end deffn
5712
5713 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5714 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5715 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5716 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5717 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5718 @end deffn
5719
5720 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5721 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5722 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5723 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5724 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5725 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5726 @end deffn
5727
5728 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5729 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5730 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5731 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5732 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5733 @end deffn
5734
5735 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5736 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5737 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5738 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5739 to the base address for each section in the image.
5740 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5741 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5742 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5743 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5744 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5745 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5746 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5747 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5748 each image section.
5749
5750 @quotation Warning
5751 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5752 data you want to preserve.
5753 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5754 sections might be erased with no notice.
5755 @itemize
5756 @item
5757 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5758 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5759 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5760 @item
5761 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5762 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5763 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5764 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5765 @end itemize
5766 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5767 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5768 @end quotation
5769
5770 @end deffn
5771
5772 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5773 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5774 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5775 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5776 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5777 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5778 ordinary memory reads.
5779 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5780 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5781 check for successful programming.
5782 @end deffn
5783
5784 @section Other Flash commands
5785 @cindex flash protection
5786
5787 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5788 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5789 and display that status.
5790 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5794 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5795 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5796
5797 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5798 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5799 and possibly stale information.
5800 @end deffn
5801
5802 @anchor{flashprotect}
5803 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5804 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5805 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5806 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5807 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5808 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5809 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5810 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5811 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5812 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5816 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5817 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5818 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5819 @end deffn
5820
5821 @anchor{program}
5822 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5823 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5824 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5825 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5826 @end deffn
5827
5828 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5829 @section Flash Driver List
5830 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5831 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5832 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5833
5834 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5835 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5836 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5837
5838 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5839
5840 @itemize
5841 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5842 @end itemize
5843
5844 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5845 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5846 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5847 @example
5848 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5849 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5850 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5851 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5852 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5853 @end example
5854 @end deffn
5855
5856 @subsection External Flash
5857
5858 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5859 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5860 @cindex CFI
5861 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5862 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5863 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5864 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5865 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5866 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5867 configure a bus and its timings), or
5868 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5869 on the flash chip.
5870 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5871 speed up operation.
5872
5873 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5874
5875 @itemize
5876 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5877 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5878 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5879 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5880 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5881 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5882 @end itemize
5883
5884 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5885 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5886
5887 @example
5888 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5889 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5890 @end example
5891
5892 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5893 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5894 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5895
5896 @example
5897 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5898 @end example
5899
5900 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5901 @end deffn
5902
5903 @anchor{jtagspi}
5904 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5905 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5906 @cindex SPI
5907 @cindex jtagspi
5908 @cindex bscan_spi
5909 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5910 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, some FPGA
5911 device provides dedicated JTAG instructions, while other FPGA devices should
5912 be programmed with a special proxy bitstream that exposes the SPI flash on
5913 the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be accessed through JTAG.
5914
5915 Since signalling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5916 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5917 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR.
5918
5919 Such a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5920 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5921 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5922
5923 This mechanism with a proxy bitstream can also be used for FPGAs from Intel and
5924 Efinix. FPGAs from Lattice and Cologne Chip have dedicated JTAG instructions
5925 and procedure to connect the JTAG to the SPI signals and don't need a proxy
5926 bitstream. Support for these devices with dedicated procedure is provided by
5927 the pld drivers. For convenience the PLD drivers will provide the USERx code
5928 for FPGAs with a proxy bitstream. Currently the following PLD drivers are able
5929 to support jtagspi:
5930 @itemize
5931 @item Efinix: proxy-bitstream
5932 @item Gatemate: dedicated procedure
5933 @item Intel/Altera: proxy-bitstream
5934 @item Lattice: dedicated procedure supporting ECP2, ECP3, ECP5, Certus and Certus Pro devices
5935 @item AMD/Xilinx: proxy-bitstream
5936 @end itemize
5937
5938
5939 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5940 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5941 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5942 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5943 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5944 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5945 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5946 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5947
5948 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5949 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5950 command, see below.
5951
5952 @itemize
5953 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5954 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5955 @var{USER1} instruction.
5956 @example
5957 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.tap
5958 set _USER1_INSTR_CODE 0x02
5959 flash bank $_FLASHNAME jtagspi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5960 $_TARGETNAME $_USER1_INSTR_CODE
5961 @end example
5962
5963 @item The option @option{-pld} @var{name} is used to have support from the
5964 PLD driver of pld device @var{name}. The name is the name of the pld device
5965 given during creation of the pld device.
5966 Pld device names are shown by the @command{pld devices} command.
5967
5968 @example
5969 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.tap
5970 set _JTAGSPI_CHAIN_ID $_CHIPNAME.pld
5971 flash bank $_FLASHNAME jtagspi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5972 $_TARGETNAME -pld $_JTAGSPI_CHAIN_ID
5973 @end example
5974 @end itemize
5975
5976 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5977 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5978 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5979 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5980 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5981 @example
5982 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5983 @end example
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5987 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5988 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5989 @example
5990 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5991 @end example
5992 @end deffn
5993
5994 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5995 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5996 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5997 @end deffn
5998 @end deffn
5999
6000 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
6001 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
6002 @cindex xcf
6003 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
6004 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
6005 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
6006 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
6007 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
6008
6009 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
6010 command accepts additional parameters:
6011 @itemize
6012 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
6013 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
6014 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
6015 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
6016 in master mode.
6017 @end itemize
6018 @example
6019 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
6020 @end example
6021 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
6022 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
6023 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
6024 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
6025 dedicated sector.
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
6029 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
6030 button.
6031 @example
6032 xcf configure 0
6033 @end example
6034 @end deffn
6035
6036 Additional driver notes:
6037 @itemize
6038 @item Only single revision supported.
6039 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
6040 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
6041 (Intel hex) file types supported.
6042 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
6043 @end itemize
6044 @end deffn
6045
6046 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
6047 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
6048 @cindex SPIFI
6049 @cindex lpcspifi
6050 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
6051 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
6052 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
6053
6054 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
6055 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
6056 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
6057 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
6058 significantly reduce flash programming times.
6059
6060 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
6061 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
6062 are configured by the driver.
6063
6064 @example
6065 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6066 @end example
6067
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
6071 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
6072 @cindex SMI
6073 @cindex stmsmi
6074 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
6075 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
6076 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
6077 SPI flash devices.
6078 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
6079 flash devices can be connected.
6080
6081 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
6082 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
6083 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
6084 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6085 the flash content.
6086
6087 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6088 to identify the memory bank.
6089 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
6090 flash size, are detected automatically.
6091
6092 @example
6093 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6094 @end example
6095
6096 @end deffn
6097
6098 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
6099 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
6100 @cindex QuadSPI
6101 @cindex OctoSPI
6102 @cindex stmqspi
6103 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
6104 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
6105 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
6106 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
6107 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
6108 mode is not.
6109
6110 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
6111 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
6112 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
6113 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
6114
6115 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
6116 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
6117 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
6118
6119 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
6120 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
6121 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
6122 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
6123 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
6124 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
6125
6126 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6127 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6128 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6129 should be avoided.
6130
6131 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6132 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6133 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6134 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6135 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6136 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6137
6138 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6139 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6140 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6141 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6142 persist across openocd invocations.
6143
6144 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6145 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6146 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6147 required (see 'set' command).
6148
6149 @example
6150 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6151 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6152 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6153 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6154 @end example
6155
6156 There are three specific commands
6157 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6158 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6159 chip specific write protection engaged.
6160 @end deffn
6161
6162 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6163 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6164 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6165 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6166 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6167 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6168
6169 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6170 which don't support an id command.
6171
6172 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6173 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6177 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6178 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6179 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6180 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6181
6182 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6183 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6184 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6185 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6186
6187 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6188
6189 To check basic communication settings, issue
6190 @example
6191 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6192 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6193 @end example
6194 for single flash mode or
6195 @example
6196 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6197 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6198 @end example
6199 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6200
6201 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6202 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6203 need a dummy address, e.g.
6204 @example
6205 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6206 @end example
6207 should return the status register contents.
6208
6209 @end deffn
6210
6211 @end deffn
6212
6213 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6214 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6215 Microcontroller platform.
6216
6217 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6218 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6219
6220 @example
6221 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6222 @end example
6223
6224 @end deffn
6225
6226 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6227 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6228 @cindex ath79
6229 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6230 chip selects.
6231 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6232 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6233 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6234 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6235 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6236 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6237
6238 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6239 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6240 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6241 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6242 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6243 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6244 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6245 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6246 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6247 with the default CS0.
6248 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6249 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6250 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6251
6252 @example
6253 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6254
6255 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6256 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6257 # distinguish the banks.
6258 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6259 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6260 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6261 @end example
6262
6263 @end deffn
6264
6265 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6266 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6267 @cindex fespi
6268
6269 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6270
6271 @example
6272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6273 @end example
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6277
6278 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6279 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6280 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6281 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6282 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6283 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6284
6285 @example
6286 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6287 @end example
6288 @end deffn
6289
6290 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6291 @cindex ambiqmicro
6292 @cindex apollo
6293 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6294 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6295 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6296 with the target using SWD.
6297
6298 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6299 the device class of the MCU.
6300 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6301 to set up the flash banks.
6302 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6303 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6304
6305 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6306 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6307 and the second bank starts after the first.
6308
6309 @example
6310 # Flash bank 0
6311 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6312 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6313 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6314 $_TARGETNAME
6315 @end example
6316
6317 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6318 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6319 are available to the user.
6320
6321 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6322
6323 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6324 Erase entire bank.
6325 @end deffn
6326 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6327 Erase device pages.
6328 @end deffn
6329 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6330 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6331 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6332 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6333 the flash.
6334 @end deffn
6335 @end deffn
6336
6337 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6338 @cindex at91samd
6339 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6340 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6341
6342 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6343
6344 The devices have one flash bank:
6345
6346 @example
6347 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6348 @end example
6349
6350 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6351 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6352 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6353 processor to be halted.
6354 @end deffn
6355
6356 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6357 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6358 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6359 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6360 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6361 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6362
6363 @example
6364 at91samd set-security enable
6365 @end example
6366 @end deffn
6367
6368 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6369 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6370 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6371 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6372 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6373 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6374 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6375 in order to disable this feature.
6376
6377 @example
6378 at91samd eeprom
6379 at91samd eeprom 1024
6380 @end example
6381 @end deffn
6382
6383 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6384 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6385 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6386 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6387 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6388 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6389
6390 @example
6391 at91samd bootloader
6392 at91samd bootloader 16384
6393 @end example
6394 @end deffn
6395
6396 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6397 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6398 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6399 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6400 @end deffn
6401
6402 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6403 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6404 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6405 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6406 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6407 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6408 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6409 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6410
6411 @example
6412 # Read user row
6413 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6414 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6415 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6416 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6417 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6418 # byte unchanged
6419 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6420 @end example
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @end deffn
6424
6425 @anchor{at91sam3}
6426 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6427 @cindex at91sam3
6428 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6429 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6430 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6431 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6432 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6433 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6434 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6435 chips are confirmed.}
6436
6437 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6438 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6439 the following fixed locations:
6440
6441 @example
6442 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6443 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6444 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6445 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6446 @end example
6447
6448 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6449 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6450 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6451
6452 @itemize
6453 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6454 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6455 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6456 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6457 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6458 @end itemize
6459
6460 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6461
6462 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6463 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6464 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6465 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6466 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6467 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6468 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6469
6470 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6471 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6472 @end deffn
6473
6474 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6475 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6476 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6477 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6478 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6479 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6480 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6481 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6485 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6486 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6487 @end deffn
6488 @end deffn
6489
6490 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6491 @cindex at91sam4
6492 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6493 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6494 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6495 @end deffn
6496
6497 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6498 @cindex at91sam4l
6499 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6500 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6501 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6502
6503 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6504 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6505 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6506 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6507 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6508 @end deffn
6509 @end deffn
6510
6511 @anchor{atsame5}
6512 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6513 @cindex atsame5
6514 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6515 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6516 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6517
6518 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6519 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6520 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6521
6522 @example
6523 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6524 @end example
6525
6526 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6527 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6528 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6529 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6530 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6531 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6532
6533 @example
6534 atsame5 bootloader
6535 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6536 @end example
6537 @end deffn
6538
6539 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6540 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6541 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6542 processor to be halted.
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6546 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6547 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6548 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6552 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6553 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6554 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6555 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6556 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6557 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6558 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6559
6560 @example
6561 # Read
6562 >atsame5 userpage
6563 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6564 # Write
6565 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6566 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6567 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6568 # bytes)
6569 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6570 @end example
6571 @end deffn
6572
6573 @end deffn
6574
6575 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6576 @cindex atsamv
6577 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6578 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6579 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6580
6581 @example
6582 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6583 @end example
6584
6585 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6586 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6587 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6588 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6589 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6590
6591 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6592 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6593 @end deffn
6594
6595 @end deffn
6596
6597 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6598 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6599 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6600 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6601 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6602
6603 @example
6604 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6605 @end example
6606
6607 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6608 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6609
6610 @itemize
6611 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6612 @item @var{banks}
6613 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6614 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6615 @item @var{pages_size}
6616 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6617 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6618 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6619 @end itemize
6620
6621 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6622 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6623 will be autoconfigured.
6624 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6625
6626 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6627 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6628 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6629 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6630 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6631
6632 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6633 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6634 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6635 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6636 are not truly general purpose).
6637 @quotation Note
6638 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6639 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6640 @end quotation
6641 @end deffn
6642 @end deffn
6643
6644 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6645 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6646 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6647 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6648 @end deffn
6649
6650 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6651 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6652 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6653 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6654
6655 @example
6656 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6657 @end example
6658
6659 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6660 each single sector one by one.
6661
6662 @example
6663 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6664 @end example
6665
6666 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6670 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6671 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6672 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6673 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6674 starts at address 0.
6675
6676 @example
6677 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6678 @end example
6679 @end deffn
6680
6681 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6682 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6683 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6684 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6685 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6686 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6687 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6688 and programming the serial flash.
6689
6690 @example
6691 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6692 @end example
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6696 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6697 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6698 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6699 autoconfigures itself.
6700 @example
6701 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6702 @end example
6703 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6704 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6705 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6706 currently not supported.
6707 @example
6708 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6709 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6710 @end example
6711
6712 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6713 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6714 this via the following command:
6715 @example
6716 efm32 debuglock num
6717 @end example
6718 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6719 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6720 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6721 supported.}
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6725 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6726 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6727 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6728 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6729 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6730
6731 @example
6732 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6733 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6734 @end example
6735
6736 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6737 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6738 @end deffn
6739
6740 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6741 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6742 is an uncommon operation.}
6743 @end deffn
6744 @end deffn
6745
6746 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6747 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6748 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6749 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6750 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6751 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6752 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6753
6754 @example
6755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6756 @end example
6757 @end deffn
6758
6759 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6760 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6761 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6762 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6763 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6764 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6765 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6766 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6767 characters) ignored.
6768
6769 @example
6770 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6771 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6772 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6773 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6774 @end example
6775 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6776 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6780 @cindex kinetis
6781 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6782 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6783 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6784 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6785 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6786 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6787
6788 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6789 @itemize
6790 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6791 @end itemize
6792
6793 @example
6794 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6795 @end example
6796
6797 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6798 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6799 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6800 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6804 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6805 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6806 set by 'flash protect' command.
6807 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6808 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6809 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6810 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6811 with the rest of a flash image.
6812 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6816 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6817 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6818 @end deffn
6819
6820 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6821 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6822 and examine-fail event.
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6826 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6827 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6828 @end deffn
6829
6830 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6831 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6832 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6833 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6834 command completes.
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6838 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6839 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6840 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6841 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6842
6843 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6844 Program Partition command.
6845
6846 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6847 Reset the device after partition setting.
6848
6849 Show partition size:
6850 @example
6851 kinetis nvm_partition info
6852 @end example
6853
6854 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6855 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6856 @example
6857 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6858 @end example
6859
6860 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6861 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6862 @example
6863 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6864 @end example
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6868 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6869 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6870 @end deffn
6871
6872 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6873 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6874 Command disables watchdog timer.
6875 @end deffn
6876 @end deffn
6877
6878 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6879 @cindex kinetis_ke
6880 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6881 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6882 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6883 autoconfigures itself.
6884 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6885
6886 @example
6887 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6888 @end example
6889
6890 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6891 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6895 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6896 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6897 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6898 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6899 @end deffn
6900
6901 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6902 Command disables watchdog timer.
6903 @end deffn
6904 @end deffn
6905
6906 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6907 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6908 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6909 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6910 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6911
6912 @quotation Note
6913 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6914 driver:
6915 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6916 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6917 @end quotation
6918
6919 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6920 which must appear in the following order:
6921
6922 @itemize
6923 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6924 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6925 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6926 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6927 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6928 LPC43x[2357])
6929 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6930 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6931 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6932 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6933 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6934 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6935 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6936 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6937 at which the core is running
6938 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6939 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6940 @quotation Note
6941 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6942 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6943 However, if you do provide it,
6944 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6945 @end quotation
6946 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6947 ROM IAP entry point.
6948 @end itemize
6949
6950 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6951
6952 @example
6953 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6954 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6955 @end example
6956
6957 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6958 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6959 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6960 @end deffn
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6964 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6965 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6966 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6967 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6968 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6969
6970 @example
6971 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6972 @end example
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6976 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6977 from NXP.
6978
6979 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6980 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6981 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6982 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6983 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6984 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6985 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6986 you start the PLL.
6987
6988 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6989
6990 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6991 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6992 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6993
6994 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6995 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6996 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6997 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6998 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6999 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
7000 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
7001
7002 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
7003 @example
7004 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
7005 @end example
7006
7007 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
7008 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
7009 @code{flash banks} command.
7010
7011 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
7012 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
7013 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
7014 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
7015 a known signature.
7016 Example:
7017 @example
7018 lpc2900 signature 0
7019 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
7020 @end example
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
7024 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
7025 saves it to a file in binary format.
7026 Example:
7027 @example
7028 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
7029 @end example
7030 @end deffn
7031
7032 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
7033 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
7034 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
7035 command:
7036
7037 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
7038 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
7039 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
7040 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
7041
7042 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
7043 Example:
7044 @example
7045 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
7046 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
7047 @end example
7048 @end deffn
7049
7050 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
7051 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
7052 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
7053 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
7054 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
7055 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
7056 912 bytes.
7057 @quotation Attention
7058 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7059 @end quotation
7060 Example:
7061 @example
7062 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
7063 @end example
7064 @end deffn
7065
7066 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
7067 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
7068 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
7069 after the next power cycle.
7070 @quotation Attention
7071 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7072 @end quotation
7073 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
7074 Example:
7075 @example
7076 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
7077 flash info 0
7078 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
7079 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7080 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
7081 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7082 @end example
7083 @end deffn
7084
7085 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
7086 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
7087 effective after the next power cycle.
7088 @quotation Attention
7089 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7090 @end quotation
7091 Examples:
7092 @example
7093 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
7094 @end example
7095 @end deffn
7096 @end deffn
7097
7098 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
7099 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
7100 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
7101 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
7102
7103 @example
7104 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
7105 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
7106 @end example
7107
7108 @itemize @bullet
7109 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
7110 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
7111 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
7112 @end itemize
7113
7114 Example usage:
7115 @example
7116 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
7117 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
7118 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
7119 @} else @{
7120 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
7121 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
7122 @}
7123 @end example
7124 @end deffn
7125
7126 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7127 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7128 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7129 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7130 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7131 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7132
7133 @example
7134 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7135 @end example
7136
7137 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7138 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7139 only the main program flash.
7140
7141 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7142 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7143 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7147 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7148 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7149 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7150
7151 To erase and program the BSL:
7152 @example
7153 msp432 bsl unlock
7154 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7155 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7156 msp432 bsl lock
7157 @end example
7158 @end deffn
7159 @end deffn
7160
7161 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7162 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7163 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7164 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7165 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7166 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7167 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7168 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7169 also have division into regions: main and info.
7170 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7171 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7172
7173 @example
7174 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7175 @end example
7176
7177 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7178
7179 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7180 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7181 @end deffn
7182
7183 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7184 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7185 @end deffn
7186
7187 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7188 Erase all userflash including info region.
7189 @end deffn
7190
7191 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7192 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7193 @end deffn
7194
7195 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7196 Check sectors protect.
7197 @end deffn
7198
7199 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7200 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7204 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7205 @end deffn
7206
7207 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7208 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7209 @end deffn
7210
7211 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7212 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7216 Show information about flash driver.
7217 @end deffn
7218
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7222 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7223 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7224 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7225 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000. An optional additional
7226 parameter sets the FIU version for the bank, with the default FIU is @var{npcx.fiu}.
7227
7228 @example
7229
7230 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME npcx_v2.fiu
7231
7232 # FIU defaults to npcx.fiu
7233 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7234
7235 @end example
7236 @end deffn
7237
7238 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7239 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7240 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7241 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7242 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7243 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7244 - ACL).
7245
7246 @example
7247 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7248 @end example
7249
7250 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7251
7252 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7253 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7254 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7255 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7256 code.
7257 @end deffn
7258
7259 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7260 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7261 @end deffn
7262
7263 @end deffn
7264
7265 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7266 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7267 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7268
7269 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7270 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7271 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7272 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7273
7274 @example
7275 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7276 @end example
7277 @end deffn
7278
7279 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7280 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7281 and integrate flash memory.
7282
7283 @example
7284 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7285 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7286 @end example
7287
7288 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7289 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7290 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7291 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7292 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7293 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7294 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7295 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7296 @end deffn
7297 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7298 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7299 This will remove any Code Protection.
7300 @end deffn
7301 @end deffn
7302
7303 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7304 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7305 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7306 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7307 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7308
7309 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7310 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7311
7312 @example
7313 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7314 @end example
7315
7316 psoc4-specific commands
7317 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7318 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7319
7320 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7321 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7322
7323 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7324 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7325 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7326
7327 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7331 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7332
7333 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7334 @end deffn
7335 @end deffn
7336
7337 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7338 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7339 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7340 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7341 apart from the base address.
7342
7343 @example
7344 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7345 @end example
7346
7347 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7348 @quotation Attention
7349 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7350 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7351 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7352 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7353 @end quotation
7354
7355 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7356
7357 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7358 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7359 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7360 @end deffn
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7364 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7365 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7366 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7367 apart from the base address.
7368
7369 @example
7370 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7371 $_TARGETNAME
7372 @end example
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7376 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7377 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7378 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7379
7380 @example
7381 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7382 @end example
7383
7384 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7385
7386 @itemize
7387 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7388 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7389 @end itemize
7390
7391 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7392
7393 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7394 @quotation Attention
7395 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7396 after successful write.
7397 @end quotation
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7401 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7402 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7403 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7404
7405 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7406 @itemize @bullet
7407 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7408 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7409 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7410 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7411 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7412 row size: 512 bytes.
7413 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7414 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7415 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7416 operation will erase row automatically.
7417 @end itemize
7418
7419 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7420 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7421
7422 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7423
7424 @example
7425 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7426 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7427 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7428 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7429 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7430 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7431 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7432 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7433 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7434 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7435 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7436 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7437
7438 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7439 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7440 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7441 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7442 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7443 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7444 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7445 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7446 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7447 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7448 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7449 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7450 @end example
7451
7452 psoc6-specific commands
7453 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7454 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7455 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7456 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7457 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7458 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7462 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7463 by @command{flash banks}.
7464 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7465 @end deffn
7466 @end deffn
7467
7468 @deffn {Flash Driver} {qn908x}
7469 The NXP QN908x microcontrollers feature a Cortex-M4F with integrated Bluetooth
7470 LE 5 support and an internal flash of up to 512 KiB. These chips only support
7471 the SWD interface.
7472
7473 The @var{qn908x} driver uses the internal "Flash Memory Controller" block via
7474 SWD to erase, program and read the internal flash. This driver does not
7475 support the ISP (In-System Programming) mode which is an alternate way to
7476 program the flash via UART, SPI or USB.
7477
7478 The internal flash is 512 KiB in size in all released chips and it starts at
7479 the address 0x01000000, although it can be mapped to address 0 and it is
7480 aliased to other addresses. This driver only recognizes the bank starting at
7481 address 0x01000000.
7482
7483 The internal bootloader stored in ROM is in charge of loading and verifying
7484 the image from flash, or enter ISP mode. The programmed image must start at
7485 the beginning of the flash and contain a valid header and a matching CRC32
7486 checksum. Additionally, the image header contains a "Code Read Protection"
7487 (CRP) word which indicates whether SWD access is enabled, as well as whether
7488 ISP mode is enabled. Therefore, it is possible to program an image that
7489 disables SWD and ISP making it impossible to program another image in the
7490 future through these interfaces, or even debug the current image. While this is
7491 a valid use case for production deployments where the chips are locked down, by
7492 default this driver doesn't allow such images that disable the SWD interface.
7493 To program such images see the @command{qn908x allow_brick} command.
7494
7495 Apart from the CRP field which is located in the image header, the last page
7496 of the flash memory contains a "Flash lock and protect" descriptor which allows
7497 to individually protect each 2 KiB page, as well as disabling SWD access to the
7498 flash and RAM. If this access is disabled it is not possible to read, erase or
7499 program individual pages from the SWD interface or even access the read-only
7500 "Flash information page" with information about the bootloader version and
7501 flash size. However when this protection is in place, it is still possible to
7502 mass erase the whole chip and then program a new image, for which you can use
7503 the @command{qn908x mass_erase}.
7504
7505 Example:
7506 @example
7507 flash bank $FLASHNAME qn908x 0x01000000 0 0 0 $TARGETNAME calc_checksum
7508 @end example
7509
7510 Parameters:
7511 @itemize
7512 @item @option{calc_checksum} optional parameter to compute the required
7513 checksum of the first bytes in the vector table.
7514 @quotation Note
7515 If the checksum in the header of your image is invalid and you don't provide the
7516 @option{calc_checksum} option the boot ROM will not boot your image and it may
7517 render the flash inaccessible. On the other hand, if you use this option to
7518 compute the checksum keep in mind that @command{verify_image} will fail on
7519 those four bytes of the checksum since those bytes in the flash will have the
7520 updated checksum.
7521 @end quotation
7522 @end itemize
7523
7524 @deffn {Command} {qn908x allow_brick}
7525 Allow the qn908x driver to program images with a "Code Read Protection" byte
7526 that disables the SWD access. Programming such image will cause OpenOCD to
7527 not be able to reach the target over SWD anymore after the new image is
7528 programmed and its configuration takes effect, e.g. after a reboot. After
7529 executing @command{qn908x allow_brick} these images will be allowed to be
7530 programmed when writing to the flash.
7531 @end deffn
7532
7533 @deffn {Command} {qn908x disable_wdog}
7534 Disable the watchdog timer (WDT) by resetting its CTRL field. The WDT starts
7535 enabled after a @command{reset halt} and it doesn't run while the target is
7536 halted. However, the verification process in this driver uses the generic
7537 Cortex-M verification process which executes a payload in RAM and thus
7538 requires the watchdog to be disabled before running @command{verify_image}
7539 after a reset halt or any other condition where the watchdog is running.
7540 Note that this is not done automatically and you must run this command in
7541 those scenarios.
7542 @end deffn
7543
7544 @deffn {Command} {qn908x mass_erase}
7545 Erases the complete flash using the mass_erase method. Mass erase is only
7546 allowed if enabled in the Lock Status Register 8 (LOCK_STAT_8) which is read
7547 from the last sector of the flash on boot. However, this mass_erase lock
7548 protection can be bypassed and this command does so automatically.
7549
7550 In the same LOCK_STAT_8 the flash and RAM access from SWD can be disabled by
7551 setting two bits in this register. After a mass_erase, all the bits of the
7552 flash would be set, making it the default to restrict SWD access to the flash
7553 and RAM regions. This new after erase LOCK_STAT_8 value only takes effect after
7554 being read from flash on the next reboot for example. After a mass_erase the
7555 LOCK_STAT_8 register is changed by the hardware to allow access to flash and
7556 RAM regardless of the value on flash, but only right after a mass_erase and
7557 until the next boot. Therefore it is possible to perform a mass_erase, program
7558 a new image, verify it and then reboot to a valid image that's locked from the
7559 SWD access.
7560
7561 The @command{qn908x mass_erase} command clears the bits that would be loaded
7562 from the flash into LOCK_STAT_8 after erasing the whole chip to allow SWD
7563 access for debugging or re-flashing an image without a mass_erase by default.
7564 If the image being programmed also programs the last page of the flash with its
7565 own settings, this mass_erase behavior will interfere with that write since a
7566 new erase of at least the last page would need to be performed before writing
7567 to it again. For this reason the optional @option{keep_lock} argument can be
7568 used to leave the flash and RAM lock set. For development environments, the
7569 default behavior is desired.
7570
7571 The mass erase locking mechanism is independent from the individual page
7572 locking bits, so it is possible that you can't erase a given page that is
7573 locked and you can't unprotect that page because the locking bits are also
7574 locked, but can still mass erase the whole flash.
7575 @end deffn
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7579 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7580 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7581 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7582 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7583
7584 @example
7585 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7586 @end example
7587 @end deffn
7588
7589 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rsl10}
7590 Supports Onsemi RSL10 microcontroller flash memory. Uses functions
7591 stored in ROM to control flash memory interface.
7592
7593 @example
7594 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rsl10 $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7595 @end example
7596
7597 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 lock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7598 Writes @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to @var{0x81044 0x81048 0x8104c
7599 0x8050}. Locks debug port by writing @var{0x4C6F634B} to @var{0x81040}.
7600
7601 To unlock use the @command{rsl10 unlock key1 key2 key3 key4} command.
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 unlock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7605 Unlocks debug port, by writing @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to
7606 registers through DAP, and clears @var{0x81040} address in flash to 0x1.
7607 @end deffn
7608
7609 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 mass_erase}
7610 Erases all unprotected flash sectors.
7611 @end deffn
7612 @end deffn
7613
7614 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7615 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7616 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7617 and SWD interface.
7618 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7619 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7620
7621 @example
7622 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7623 @end example
7624
7625 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7626
7627 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7628 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7629 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7633 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7634 @end deffn
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7638 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7639 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7640 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7641 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7642
7643 @example
7644 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7645 @end example
7646
7647 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7648 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7649 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7650 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7651 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7652 disabled.
7653
7654 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7655 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7656 @quotation Warning
7657 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7658 applied to all of them.
7659 @end quotation
7660 @end deffn
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7664 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7665 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7666 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7667 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7668 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7669 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7670
7671 @example
7672 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7673 @end example
7674
7675 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7676 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7677 the flash driver.
7678
7679 @example
7680 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7681 @end example
7682
7683 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7684 as per the following example.
7685 @example
7686 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7687 @end example
7688
7689 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7690
7691 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7692 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7693 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7694 @end deffn
7695
7696 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7697 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7698 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7699 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7700 @end deffn
7701
7702 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7703 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7705 @end deffn
7706
7707 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7708 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7709 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7710 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7714 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7715 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7716 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7717 @end deffn
7718
7719 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7720 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7721 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7722 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7723 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7724 @end deffn
7725 @end deffn
7726
7727 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7728 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7729 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7730 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7731 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7732
7733 @example
7734 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7735 @end example
7736
7737 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7738 as per the following example.
7739 @example
7740 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7741 @end example
7742
7743 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7744 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7745 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7749 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7750 the flash driver.
7751
7752 @example
7753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7754 @end example
7755
7756 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7757
7758 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7759 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7760 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7761 @end deffn
7762
7763 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7764 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7765 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7766 @end deffn
7767
7768 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7769 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7770 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7771 @end deffn
7772
7773 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7774 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7775 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7776 @end deffn
7777
7778 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7779 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7780 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7781 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7782 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7783 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7784 @end deffn
7785
7786 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7787 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7788 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7789 @end deffn
7790 @end deffn
7791
7792 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7793 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7794 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7795 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7796 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7797
7798 @example
7799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7800 @end example
7801
7802 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7803 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7804 the flash driver.
7805
7806 @example
7807 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7808 @end example
7809
7810 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7811
7812 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7813 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7814 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7815 @end deffn
7816
7817 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7818 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7819 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7820 @end deffn
7821
7822 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7823 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7824 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7825 @end deffn
7826
7827 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7828 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7829 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7830 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7831 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7832
7833 Example usage:
7834 @example
7835 # read OPTSR_CUR
7836 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7837 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7838 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7839 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7840 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7841 @end example
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7845 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7846 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7847 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7848 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7849 will be touched).
7850
7851 Example usage:
7852 @example
7853 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7854 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7855 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7856 @end example
7857 @end deffn
7858 @end deffn
7859
7860 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7861 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7862 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7863 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7864 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7865
7866 @example
7867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7868 @end example
7869
7870 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7871 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7872 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7873 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7874 second bank.
7875
7876 @example
7877 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7878 @end example
7879
7880 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7881
7882 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7883 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7884 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7885 @end deffn
7886
7887 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7888 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7889 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7893 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7894 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7895 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7896 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7897 @end deffn
7898 @end deffn
7899
7900 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7901 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7902 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7903 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7904 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7905 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7906
7907 @example
7908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7909 @end example
7910
7911 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7912 as per the following example.
7913 @example
7914 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7915 @end example
7916
7917 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7918 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7919 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7920 @end deffn
7921
7922 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7923 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7924 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7925 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7926
7927 @example
7928 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7929 @end example
7930
7931 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7932
7933 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7934 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7935 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7936
7937 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7938 @end deffn
7939
7940 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7941 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7942 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7943
7944 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7945 @end deffn
7946
7947 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7948 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7949 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7953 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7954 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7955 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7956
7957 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7958 @example
7959 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7960 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7961 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7962 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7963 @end example
7964
7965 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7966 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7967 @end deffn
7968
7969 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7970 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7971 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7972 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7973 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7974
7975 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7976
7977 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7978 @example
7979 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7980 @end example
7981
7982 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7983 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7984 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7985 @end deffn
7986
7987 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7988 List the protected areas using WRP.
7989 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7990 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7991 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7992
7993 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7994 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7995 in single or dual-banks mode.
7996 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7997 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7998
7999 @end deffn
8000
8001 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
8002 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
8003 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
8007 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
8008 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
8009 the TrustZone status.
8010 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
8011 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
8012 @end deffn
8013 @end deffn
8014
8015 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
8016 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
8017 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
8018 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
8019 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
8020
8021 @example
8022 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
8023 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
8024 @end example
8025
8026 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
8027 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
8028 for the specified flash bank.
8029 @end deffn
8030 @end deffn
8031
8032 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
8033 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
8034 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
8035 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
8036 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
8037
8038 @example
8039 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
8040 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
8041 @end example
8042
8043 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
8044 Configures the str9 flash controller.
8045 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
8046
8047 @itemize @bullet
8048 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
8049 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
8050 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
8051 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
8052 @end itemize
8053 @end deffn
8054
8055 @end deffn
8056
8057 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
8058 @cindex str9xpec
8059
8060 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
8061 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
8062 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
8063 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
8064
8065 Here is some background info to help
8066 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
8067 the str9:
8068 @enumerate
8069 @item
8070 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
8071 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
8072 @item
8073 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
8074 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
8075 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
8076 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
8077 @end enumerate
8078
8079 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
8080 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
8081 configured for flash bank 0.
8082 @example
8083 # assert srst, we do not want core running
8084 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
8085 adapter assert srst
8086 # turn off target polling
8087 poll off
8088 # disable str9 core
8089 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
8090 # read option bytes
8091 str9xpec options_read 0
8092 # re-enable str9 core
8093 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
8094 poll on
8095 reset halt
8096 @end example
8097 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
8098 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
8099 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
8100 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
8101
8102 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
8103
8104 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
8105 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
8106 @end deffn
8107
8108 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
8109 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
8110 directly to the embedded flash controller.
8111 @end deffn
8112
8113 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
8114 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
8115 erase the device.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
8119 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
8120 @end deffn
8121
8122 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
8123 Configure str9 boot bank.
8124 @end deffn
8125
8126 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8127 Configure str9 lvd source.
8128 @end deffn
8129
8130 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
8131 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8135 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
8136 @end deffn
8137
8138 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
8139 Read str9 option bytes.
8140 @end deffn
8141
8142 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
8143 Write str9 option bytes.
8144 @end deffn
8145
8146 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
8147 unlock str9 device.
8148 @end deffn
8149
8150 @end deffn
8151
8152 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
8153 @cindex swm050
8154 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
8155
8156 @example
8157 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
8158 @end example
8159
8160 One swm050-specific command is defined:
8161
8162 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
8163 Erases the entire flash bank.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @end deffn
8167
8168
8169 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
8170 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
8171 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
8172 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8173
8174 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
8175
8176 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
8177 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
8178 @end deffn
8179
8180 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
8181 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
8182 @end deffn
8183
8184 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
8185 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
8186 the flash clock.
8187 @end deffn
8188 @end deffn
8189
8190 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
8191 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
8192 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
8193 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
8194 correct bank config.
8195
8196 @example
8197 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
8198 @end example
8199 @end deffn
8200
8201 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
8202 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8203 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8204 @end deffn
8205
8206 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
8207 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8208 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8209
8210 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
8211
8212 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
8213 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
8214 @end deffn
8215
8216 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
8217 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
8218 @end deffn
8219
8220 @end deffn
8221
8222 @section NAND Flash Commands
8223 @cindex NAND
8224
8225 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
8226 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
8227 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
8228
8229 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
8230 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
8231 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
8232 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
8233 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
8234 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
8235
8236 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
8237 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
8238 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
8239 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
8240 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
8241 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
8242 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
8243 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8244 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8245 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8246
8247 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8248 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8249 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8250 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8251 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8252 every 512 bytes of data.
8253
8254 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8255 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8256 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8257 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8258 ECC mode is used.
8259
8260 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8261 @enumerate
8262 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8263 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8264 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8265 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8266 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8267 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8268 to access that device.
8269 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8270 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8271 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8272 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8273 de-brick a board.
8274 @end enumerate
8275
8276 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8277 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8278 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8279 are only 32 bits wide.
8280 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8281 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8282 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8283 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8284
8285 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8286 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8287 @cindex NAND configuration
8288
8289 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8290 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8291 OpenOCD has initialized.
8292
8293 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8294 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8295 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8296 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8297 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8298 they were a single (larger) device.
8299 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8300 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8301
8302 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8303 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8304 configuration files, not interactively.
8305
8306 @itemize @bullet
8307 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8308 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8309 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8310 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8311 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8312 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8313 commands to the NAND controller.
8314 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8315 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8316 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8317 for more information.
8318 @end itemize
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8322 Prints a summary of each device declared
8323 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8324 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8325 @example
8326 > nand list
8327 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8328 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8329 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8330 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8331 >
8332 @end example
8333 @end deffn
8334
8335 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8336 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8337 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8338 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8339 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8340 it with most other NAND commands.
8341 @end deffn
8342
8343 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8344
8345 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8346 @cindex NAND reading
8347 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8348 starting at the specified offset.
8349 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8350
8351 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8352 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8353
8354 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8355 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8356 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8357
8358 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8359 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8360 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8361 method which handled that error correction.
8362
8363 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8364 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8365 @itemize @bullet
8366 @item no oob_* parameter
8367 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8368 @item @code{oob_raw}
8369 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8370 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8371 spare areas associated with each data page.
8372 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8373 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8374 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8375 @item @code{oob_only}
8376 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8377 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8378 spare areas associated with each data page.
8379 @end itemize
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8383 @cindex NAND erasing
8384 @cindex NAND programming
8385 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8386 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8387 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8388 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8389 If those parameters are not specified,
8390 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8391 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8392
8393 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8394 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8395 block marker.
8396 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8397 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8398 @end deffn
8399
8400 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8401 @cindex NAND writing
8402 @cindex NAND programming
8403 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8404 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8405 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8406 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8407
8408 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8409 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8410
8411 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8412 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8413 past the end of the device.
8414 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8415 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8416 if that's being written.)
8417
8418 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8419 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8420 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8421
8422 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8423 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8424 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8425 @itemize @bullet
8426 @item no oob_* parameter
8427 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8428 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8429 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8430 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8431 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8432 @item @code{oob_only}
8433 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8434 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8435 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8436 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8437 @item @code{oob_raw}
8438 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8439 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8440 un-altered OOB.
8441 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8442 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8443 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8444 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8445 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8446 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8447 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8448 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8449 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8450 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8451 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8452 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8453 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8454 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8455 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8456 @end itemize
8457 @end deffn
8458
8459 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8460 @cindex NAND verification
8461 @cindex NAND programming
8462 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8463 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8464 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8465
8466 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8467 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8468
8469 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8470 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8471 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8472 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8473 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8474
8475 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8476 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8477 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8478
8479 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8480 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8481 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8482 be removed in a future release.
8483 @end deffn
8484
8485 @subsection Other NAND commands
8486 @cindex NAND other commands
8487
8488 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8489 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8490 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8491 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8492 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8493 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8494 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8495 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8496
8497 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8498 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8499 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8500 @end deffn
8501
8502 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8503 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8504 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8505 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8506 status for each block.
8507 @end deffn
8508
8509 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8510 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8511 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8512
8513 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8514 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8515 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8516 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8517 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8518
8519 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8520 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8521 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8522 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8523 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8524 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8525 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8529 @subsection NAND Driver List
8530 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8531 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8532 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8533
8534 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8535 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8536 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8537 address of the ECC controller.
8538 @example
8539 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8540 @end example
8541 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8542 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8543 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8544 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8545 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8546 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8547 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8548 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8549 @end deffn
8550 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8551 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8552 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8556 properly configured for input or output.
8557 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8558 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8559 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8560 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8561 @end deffn
8562 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8563 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8564 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8565 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8566 @end deffn
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8570 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8571 chips from Texas Instruments.
8572 It takes three extra parameters:
8573 address of the NAND chip;
8574 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8575 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8576 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8577 @example
8578 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8579 @end example
8580 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8581 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8582 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8583 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8584 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8585 @end deffn
8586
8587 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8588 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8589 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8590 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8591 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8592 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8593 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8594 @end deffn
8595
8596 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8597 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8598 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8599 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8600 @end deffn
8601 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8602
8603 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8604 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8605 should work for this chip as well.
8606 @end deffn
8607
8608 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8609 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8610 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8611 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8612 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8613 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8614 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8615 @example
8616 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8617 @end example
8618 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8619 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8620 without parameter query status.
8621 @end deffn
8622 @end deffn
8623
8624 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8625 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8626 parameter: the address of the controller.
8627 @example
8628 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8629 @end example
8630 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8631 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8632 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8633 change any behavior.
8634 @end deffn
8635
8636 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8637 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8638 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8639 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8640 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8641 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8642 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8643 specialized commands.
8644 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8645 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8646 change any behavior.
8647 @end deffn
8648
8649 @node Flash Programming
8650 @chapter Flash Programming
8651
8652 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8653 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8654 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8655
8656 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8657 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8658
8659 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8660 @enumerate
8661 @item 'init' is executed.
8662 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8663 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8664 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8665 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8666 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8667 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8668 @end enumerate
8669
8670 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8671
8672 @example
8673 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8674 # are optional parameters
8675 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8676 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8677
8678 # binary files need the flash address passing
8679 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8680 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8681 @end example
8682
8683 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8684 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8685 @cindex PLD
8686 @cindex FPGA
8687
8688 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8689 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8690 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8691 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8692 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8693 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8694 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8695
8696 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8697
8698 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8699 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8700 Also, each such PLD requires a driver. PLD drivers may also be needed to program
8701 SPI flash connected to the FPGA to store the bitstream (@xref{jtagspi} for details).
8702
8703 They are referenced by the name which was given when the pld was created or
8704 the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command.
8705 New PLDs are defined by @command{pld create pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]}.
8706
8707 @deffn {Config Command} {pld create} pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]
8708 Creates a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8709 assigning @var{pld_name} for further reference.
8710 @code{-chain-position} @var{tap_name} names the TAP
8711 used to access this target.
8712 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its behavior.
8713 @end deffn
8714
8715 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8716 List the known PLDs with their name.
8717 @end deffn
8718
8719 @deffn {Command} {pld load} pld_name filename
8720 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{pld_name}.
8721 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8722 @end deffn
8723
8724 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8725
8726 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8727 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8728 that particular type of PLD.
8729
8730 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [@option{-no_jstart}]
8731 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8732 This driver can also be used to load Series3, Series6, Series7 and Zynq 7000 devices.
8733 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8734
8735 If @var{-no_jstart} is given, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8736 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8737 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8738
8739 @example
8740 openocd -f board/digilent_zedboard.cfg -c "init" \
8741 -c "pld load 0 zedboard_bitstream.bit"
8742 @end example
8743
8744
8745 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} pld_name
8746 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8747 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8748 @end deffn
8749
8750 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_instr_codes} pld_name cfg_out cfg_in jprogb jstart jshutdown [user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]]
8751 Change values for boundary scan instructions. Default are values for Virtex 2, devices Virtex 4/5/6 and
8752 SSI devices are using different values.
8753 @var{pld_name} is the name of the pld device.
8754 @var{cfg_out} is the value used to select CFG_OUT instruction.
8755 @var{cfg_in} is the value used to select CFG_IN instruction.
8756 @var{jprogb} is the value used to select JPROGRAM instruction.
8757 @var{jstart} is the value used to select JSTART instruction.
8758 @var{jshutdown} is the value used to select JSHUTDOWN instruction.
8759 @var{user1} to @var{user4} are the intruction used to select the user registers USER1 to USER4.
8760 @end deffn
8761
8762 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_user_codes} pld_name user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]
8763 Change values for boundary scan instructions selecting the registers USER1 to USER4.
8764 Description of the arguments can be found at command @command{virtex2 set_instr_codes}.
8765 @end deffn
8766
8767 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 refresh} pld_name
8768 Load the bitstream from external memory for FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a. program.
8769 @end deffn
8770 @end deffn
8771
8772
8773
8774 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {lattice} [@option{-family} <name>]
8775 The FGPA families ECP2, ECP3, ECP5, Certus and CertusPro by Lattice are supported.
8776 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA or read the status register and read/write the usercode register.
8777
8778 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{ecp2 ecp3 ecp5 certus}. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8779
8780 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_status} pld_name
8781 Reads and displays the status register
8782 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8783 @end deffn
8784
8785 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_user} pld_name
8786 Reads and displays the user register
8787 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8788 @end deffn
8789
8790 @deffn {Command} {lattice write_user} pld_name val
8791 Writes the user register.
8792 for FPGA @var{pld_name} with value @var{val}.
8793 @end deffn
8794
8795 @deffn {Command} {lattice set_preload} pld_name length
8796 Set the length of the register for the preload. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8797 The load command for the FPGA @var{pld_name} will use a length for the preload of @var{length}.
8798 @end deffn
8799
8800 @deffn {Command} {lattice refresh} pld_name
8801 Load the bitstream from external memory for FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a program.
8802 @end deffn
8803 @end deffn
8804
8805
8806 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {efinix} [@option{-family} <name>]
8807 Both families (Trion and Titanium) sold by Efinix are supported as both use the same protocol for In-System Configuration.
8808 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA.
8809 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{trion|titanium}.
8810 @end deffn
8811
8812
8813 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {intel} [@option{-family} <name>]
8814 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into Intel (former Altera) FPGAs.
8815 The families Cyclone III, Cyclone IV, Cyclone V, Cyclone 10, Arria II are supported.
8816 @c Arria V and Arria 10, MAX II, MAX V, MAX10)
8817
8818 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{cycloneiii cycloneiv cyclonev cyclone10 arriaii}.
8819 This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is ambiguous (same ID is used for chips in different families).
8820
8821 As input file format the driver supports a '.rbf' (raw bitstream file) file. The '.rbf' file can be generated
8822 from a '.sof' file with @verb{|quartus_cpf -c blinker.sof blinker.rbf|}
8823
8824 Creates a new PLD device, an FPGA of the Cyclone III family, using the TAP named @verb{|cycloneiii.tap|}:
8825 @example
8826 pld create cycloneiii.pld intel -chain-position cycloneiii.tap -family cycloneiii
8827 @end example
8828
8829 @deffn {Command} {intel set_bscan} pld_name len
8830 Set boundary scan register length of FPGA @var{pld_name} to @var{len}. This is needed because the
8831 length can vary between chips with the same JTAG ID.
8832 @end deffn
8833
8834 @deffn {Command} {intel set_check_pos} pld_name pos
8835 Selects the position @var{pos} in the boundary-scan register. The bit at this
8836 position is checked after loading the bitstream and must be '1', which is the case when no error occurred.
8837 With a value of -1 for @var{pos} the check will be omitted.
8838 @end deffn
8839 @end deffn
8840
8841
8842 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gowin}
8843 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into FPGAs from Gowin.
8844 It is possible to program the SRAM. Programming the flash is not supported.
8845 The files @verb{|.fs|} and @verb{|.bin|} generated by Gowin FPGA Designer are supported.
8846
8847 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_status} pld_name
8848 Reads and displays the status register
8849 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8850 @end deffn
8851
8852 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_user} pld_name
8853 Reads and displays the user register
8854 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8855 @end deffn
8856
8857 @deffn {Command} {gowin refresh} pld_name
8858 Load the bitstream from external memory for
8859 FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a. reload.
8860 @end deffn
8861 @end deffn
8862
8863
8864 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gatemate}
8865 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into GateMate FPGAs form CologneChip.
8866 The files @verb{|.bit|} and @verb{|.cfg|} both generated by p_r tool from CologneChip are supported.
8867 @end deffn
8868
8869
8870 @node General Commands
8871 @chapter General Commands
8872 @cindex commands
8873
8874 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8875 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8876 commands are documented elsewhere.
8877
8878 Intent:
8879 @itemize @bullet
8880 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8881 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8882 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8883 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8884
8885 @item @b{From the human}
8886 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8887 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8888
8889 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8890 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8891 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8892
8893 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8894 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8895 port is 6666.
8896 @end itemize
8897
8898
8899 @section Server Commands
8900
8901 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8902 Exits the current telnet session.
8903 @end deffn
8904
8905 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8906 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8907 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8908 Not every command provides helptext.
8909
8910 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8911 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8912 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8913 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8917 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8918 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8919 containing @var{string}.
8920 Not every command provides helptext.
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8924 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8925 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8926 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8927 Useful in connection with script files
8928 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8929 @end deffn
8930
8931 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8932 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8933 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8934 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8935
8936 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8937 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8938
8939 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8940 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8941 @example
8942 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8943 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8944 @end example
8945 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8946 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8947 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8948 will proceed to quit.
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @anchor{debuglevel}
8952 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8953 @cindex message level
8954 Display debug level.
8955 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8956 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8957 Level 0 is error messages only;
8958 level 1 adds warnings;
8959 level 2 adds informational messages;
8960 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8961 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8962 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8963 the command line along with the location of that log
8964 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8965 @xref{Running}.
8966 @end deffn
8967
8968 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8969 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8970 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8971 @example
8972 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8973 @end example
8974 @end deffn
8975
8976 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8977 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8978 the default log output channel is stderr.
8979 @end deffn
8980
8981 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8982 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8983 @end deffn
8984
8985 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8986 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8987 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8988 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8989 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8993 @section Target State handling
8994 @cindex reset
8995 @cindex halt
8996 @cindex target initialization
8997
8998 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8999 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
9000 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
9001 a current target which is used to perform the
9002 various operations. The current target may be changed
9003 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
9004 target which should become current.
9005
9006 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
9007 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
9008 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
9009 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
9010 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
9011
9012 @emph{With no arguments}:
9013 list all available registers for the current target,
9014 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
9015 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
9016 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
9017 are flagged as such.
9018
9019 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
9020 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
9021 bypassing any internal cache.
9022
9023 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
9024 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
9025 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
9026 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
9027 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
9028 relevant module will flush such values.
9029
9030 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
9031 Debug and trace infrastructure:
9032
9033 @example
9034 > reg
9035 ===== ARM registers
9036 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
9037 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
9038 (2) r2 (/32)
9039 ...
9040 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
9041 >
9042 @end example
9043 @end deffn
9044
9045 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
9046 Set register values of the target.
9047
9048 @itemize
9049 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
9050 @end itemize
9051
9052 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
9053 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
9054
9055 @example
9056 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
9057 @end example
9058 @end deffn
9059
9060 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
9061 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
9062 of register names and values.
9063 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
9064 target, bypassing any caching.
9065
9066 @itemize
9067 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
9068 @end itemize
9069
9070 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
9071 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
9072
9073 @example
9074 get_reg @{pc sp@}
9075 @end example
9076 @end deffn
9077
9078 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
9079 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
9080 script.
9081
9082 @itemize
9083 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
9084 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
9085 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
9086 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
9087 @end itemize
9088
9089 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
9090 memory at address 0x20000000:
9091
9092 @example
9093 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
9094 @end example
9095 @end deffn
9096
9097 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
9098 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
9099 script.
9100 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
9101
9102 @itemize
9103 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
9104 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
9105 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
9106 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
9107 @end itemize
9108
9109 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
9110 memory at address 0x20000000:
9111
9112 @example
9113 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
9114 @end example
9115 @end deffn
9116
9117 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
9118 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
9119 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
9120 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
9121 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
9122 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
9123 (and enter debug mode).
9124 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
9125
9126 @quotation Warning
9127 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
9128 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
9129 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
9130 power mode by gating the core clock;
9131 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
9132
9133 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
9134 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
9135 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
9136 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
9137 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
9138 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
9139
9140 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
9141 work with a JTAG debugger.
9142 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
9143 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9144 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
9145 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
9146 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
9147 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
9148 @end quotation
9149
9150 @end deffn
9151
9152 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
9153 Resume the target at its current code position,
9154 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
9158 Single-step the target at its current code position,
9159 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9160 @end deffn
9161
9162 @anchor{resetcommand}
9163 @deffn {Command} {reset}
9164 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
9165 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
9166 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
9167 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
9168 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
9169 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
9170
9171 The optional parameter specifies what should
9172 happen after the reset.
9173 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
9174 The other options will not work on all systems.
9175 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9176
9177 @itemize @minus
9178 @item @b{run} Let the target run
9179 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
9180 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
9181 @end itemize
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
9185 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
9186 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
9187 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
9188 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
9189 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
9190 state.
9191 @end deffn
9192
9193 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9194 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9195 Set values of reset signals.
9196 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
9197 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
9198 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
9199 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
9200
9201 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9202 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
9203 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9204 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9205 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
9206 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
9207 the signal will not be modified.
9208
9209 @quotation Note
9210 TRST is specially handled.
9211 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9212 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9213 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9214 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9215 instead of the TRST signal.
9216 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9217 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9218 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9219 with handlers for that event.
9220 @end quotation
9221 @end deffn
9222
9223 @anchor{memoryaccess}
9224 @section Memory access commands
9225 @cindex memory access
9226
9227 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
9228 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
9229 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
9230 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
9231
9232 @enumerate
9233 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
9234 to change the current target.
9235 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
9236 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
9237 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
9238 @end enumerate
9239
9240 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
9241 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
9242 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
9243 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
9244 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
9245 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
9246 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
9247 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
9248 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9249 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9250 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9251 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9252 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
9253 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
9254 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
9255 @end deffn
9256
9257 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
9258 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
9259 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
9260 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
9261 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
9262 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
9263 at the specified address @var{addr}.
9264 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9265 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9266 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9267 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9268 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
9269 @end deffn
9270
9271 @anchor{imageaccess}
9272 @section Image loading commands
9273 @cindex image loading
9274 @cindex image dumping
9275
9276 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
9277 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
9278 binary file named @var{filename}.
9279 @end deffn
9280
9281 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
9282 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
9283 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
9284 @end deffn
9285
9286 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
9287 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
9288 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
9289 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
9290 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
9291 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
9292 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
9293 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
9294 separately.
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
9298 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
9299 The file format may optionally be specified
9300 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
9301 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
9302 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
9303 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
9304 @example
9305 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
9306 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
9307 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
9308 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
9309 $address $length
9310 @}
9311 @end example
9312 @end deffn
9313
9314 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
9315 Displays image section sizes and addresses
9316 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
9317 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
9318 The file format may optionally be specified
9319 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9323 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9324 The file format may optionally be specified
9325 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9326 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
9327 @end deffn
9328
9329 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9330 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9331 The file format may optionally be specified
9332 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9333 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
9334 @end deffn
9335
9336
9337 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
9338 @cindex breakpoint
9339 @cindex watchpoint
9340
9341 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
9342 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
9343 watchpoints.
9344 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
9345
9346 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
9347 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
9348 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
9349 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9350 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
9351 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
9352
9353 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
9354 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
9355 @end deffn
9356
9357 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
9358 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
9359 @end deffn
9360
9361 @deffn {Command} {rwp} @option{all} | address
9362 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address} or all watchpoints.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
9366 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
9367 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9368 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
9369 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
9370 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
9371 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9372 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9373 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9374 @end deffn
9375
9376
9377 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9378
9379 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9380 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9381 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9382 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9383 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9384 running, can be used.
9385 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9386 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9387 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9388
9389 @quotation Note
9390 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9391 @end quotation
9392
9393 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9394 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9395 communication, respectively.
9396
9397 @quotation Note
9398 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9399 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9400 example.
9401 @end quotation
9402
9403 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9404 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9405 of TCP/IP connections.
9406
9407 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9408 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9409 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9410 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9411 @var{size} bytes.
9412 @end deffn
9413
9414 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9415 Start RTT.
9416 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9420 Stop RTT.
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9424 Display the polling interval.
9425 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9426 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9427 checked for new data.
9428 @end deffn
9429
9430 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9431 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9435 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9436 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9437 @end deffn
9438
9439 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9440 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9441 @end deffn
9442
9443 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9444 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9448 on the target device.
9449
9450 @example
9451 resume
9452
9453 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9454 rtt start
9455
9456 rtt server start 9090 0
9457 @end example
9458
9459 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9460 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9461 TCP/IP port 9090.
9462
9463
9464 @section Misc Commands
9465
9466 @cindex profiling
9467 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9468 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9469 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9470 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9471 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9472 limit the address range.
9473 @end deffn
9474
9475 @deffn {Command} {version} [git]
9476 Returns a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9477 With option @option{git}, it returns the git version obtained at compile time
9478 through ``git describe''.
9479 @end deffn
9480
9481 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9482 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9483 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9484 @end deffn
9485
9486 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9487 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9491 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9495 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9496 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9497 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9498
9499 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9500 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9501 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9502 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9503
9504 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9505 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9506 @cindex tracing
9507 @cindex ETM
9508 @cindex ETB
9509
9510 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9511 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9512 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9513
9514 @itemize
9515 @item
9516 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9517 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9518 supports such an interface.
9519 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9520 and trace port support.)
9521 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9522 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9523 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9524 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9525 in the board-specific configuration file.
9526 @item
9527 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9528 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9529 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9530 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9531 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9532 @end itemize
9533
9534 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9535
9536 @quotation Issues
9537 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9538 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9539
9540 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9541 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9542 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9543 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9544 dummy trace port driver}.
9545
9546 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9547 as well as tracing only during specific states
9548 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9549
9550 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9551 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9552 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9553 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9554 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9555
9556 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9557 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9558 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9559 this original style of JTAG access.
9560 @end quotation
9561
9562 @subsection ETM Configuration
9563 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9564
9565 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9566 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9567 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9568
9569 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9570 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9571 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9572 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9573 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9574 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9575 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9576 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9577 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9578
9579 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9580 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9581 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9582
9583 @quotation Warning
9584 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9585 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9586 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9587 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9588 @end quotation
9589
9590 @quotation Note
9591 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9592 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9593 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9594 what CPU activities are traced.
9595 @end quotation
9596 @end deffn
9597
9598 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9599 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9600 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9601 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9602 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9603 @end deffn
9604
9605 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9606 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9607 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9608 Did trace data overflow?
9609 Was it triggered?
9610 @end deffn
9611
9612 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9613 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9614 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9615 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9616 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9617
9618 @itemize
9619 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9620 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9621 The value is one of
9622 @option{none} (save nothing),
9623 @option{data} (save data),
9624 @option{address} (save addresses),
9625 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9626 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9627 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9628 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9629 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9630 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9631 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9632 trace stream without an image of the code.
9633 @end itemize
9634 @end deffn
9635
9636 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9637 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9638 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9639 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9640 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9641
9642 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9643 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9644 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9645 @end deffn
9646
9647 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9648
9649 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9650 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9651 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9652
9653 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9654 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9655 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9656 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9657 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9658 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9659 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9660
9661 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9662
9663 @itemize
9664 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9665 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9666 for instruction access within that function's body.
9667 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9668 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9669 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9670 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9671 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9672 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9673 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9674 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9675 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9676 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9677 @item @emph{... more}
9678 @end itemize
9679
9680 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9681 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9682
9683 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9684 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9685 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9686 @end deffn
9687
9688 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9689 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9690 @end deffn
9691
9692 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9693 Opens an image file.
9694 @end deffn
9695
9696 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9697 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9698 @end deffn
9699
9700 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9701 Starts trace data collection.
9702 @end deffn
9703
9704 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9705 Stops trace data collection.
9706 @end deffn
9707
9708 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9709 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9710
9711 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9712
9713 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9714 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9715 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9716 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9717 any trace data collection.}
9718 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9719 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9720 @end deffn
9721 @end deffn
9722
9723 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9724 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9725 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9726 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9727 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9728 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9729 @end deffn
9730 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9731 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9732 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9733 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9734 trace trigger becomes active.
9735
9736 @itemize
9737 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9738 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9739 afterwards.
9740 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9741 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9742 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9743 what caused that event to happen.
9744 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9745 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9746 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9747 how the event caused trouble.
9748 @end itemize
9749 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9750 @end deffn
9751
9752 @end deffn
9753
9754 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9755 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9756 @cindex CTI
9757
9758 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9759 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9760 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9761 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9762 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9763 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9764
9765 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9766 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9767 @var{apn}.
9768 On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9769 On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9770 The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9771 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9772 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9773 including additional configuration.
9774 @end deffn
9775
9776 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9777 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9778 @end deffn
9779
9780 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9781 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9782 @end deffn
9783
9784 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9785 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9786 @end deffn
9787
9788 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9789 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9790 @end deffn
9791
9792 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9793 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9794 @end deffn
9795
9796 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9797 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9798 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9799 @end deffn
9800
9801 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9802 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9803 of the CTI.
9804 @end deffn
9805
9806 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9807 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9808 useful in TCL scripting.
9809 @end deffn
9810
9811 @section Generic ARM
9812 @cindex ARM
9813
9814 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9815 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9816 commands that may be available.
9817
9818 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9819 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9820 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9821 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9822 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9823 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9827 @cindex disassemble
9828 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9829 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9830 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9831 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9832 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9833 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9834 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9835
9836 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9837 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9838 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9839 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9840 with a handful of exceptions.
9841 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9842 @end deffn
9843
9844 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9845 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9846 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9847 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9848 and using the MCR instruction.
9849 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9850 an ARM register.)
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9854 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9855 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9856 and the MRC instruction.
9857 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9858 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9859 an ARM register.)
9860 @end deffn
9861
9862 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9863 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9864 core mode if necessary.
9865 @end deffn
9866
9867 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9868 @cindex ARM semihosting
9869 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9870
9871 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9872 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9873 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9874 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9875 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9876 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9877 @end deffn
9878
9879 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port> [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all}])
9880 @cindex ARM semihosting
9881 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9882
9883 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9884 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9885 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9886
9887 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9888 @end deffn
9889
9890 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9891 @cindex ARM semihosting
9892 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9893
9894 @example
9895 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9896 @end example
9897
9898 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9899 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9900 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9901 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9902 @end deffn
9903
9904 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9905 @cindex ARM semihosting
9906 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9907 status.
9908
9909 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9910 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9911 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9912 debugger.
9913 @end deffn
9914
9915 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9916 @cindex ARM semihosting
9917 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9918
9919 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9920 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9921 the value returned by the target.
9922
9923 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9924 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9925 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9926 encountering a break.
9927
9928 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9929 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9930 to the debugger.
9931 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9932 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9933 request or equivalent").
9934
9935 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9936 this option (default: disabled).
9937 @end deffn
9938
9939 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9940 @cindex ARM semihosting
9941 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9942 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9943
9944 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9945 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9946 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9947 command.
9948 @end deffn
9949
9950 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9951 @cindex ARM semihosting
9952 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
9953 Use "." for the current directory.
9954 @end deffn
9955
9956 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9957 @cindex ARMv4
9958 @cindex ARMv5
9959
9960 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9961 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9962 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9963 variant.
9964
9965 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9966 @cindex ARM7
9967 @cindex ARM9
9968
9969 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9970 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9971 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9972 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9973
9974 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9975 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9976 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9977 instead of breakpoints.
9978 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9979
9980 This should be
9981 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9982 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9983 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9984 @end deffn
9985
9986 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9987 @cindex DCC
9988 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9989 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9990 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9991
9992 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9993 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9994 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9995 @end deffn
9996
9997 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9998 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9999 that don't check completion of the operation.
10000 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10001
10002 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
10003 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
10004 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
10005 @end deffn
10006
10007 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
10008 @cindex ARM9
10009
10010 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
10011 integer processors.
10012 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
10013
10014 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
10015 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
10016 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
10017 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
10018
10019 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
10020 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10021 @cindex vector_catch
10022 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
10023 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
10024 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
10025 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
10026 to those hardware vectors.
10027
10028 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
10029 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
10030 vector catch hardware to intercept
10031 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
10032 @option{none} of them,
10033 or a list with one or more of the following:
10034 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
10035 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
10036 @end deffn
10037
10038 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
10039 @cindex ARM920T
10040
10041 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
10042 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
10043 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
10044 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10045 and ARM9 commands.
10046
10047 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
10048 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
10049 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
10053 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10054 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10055 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
10056 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
10057 (Not all registers can be written.)
10058 @end deffn
10059
10060 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
10061 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
10065 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
10066 @end deffn
10067
10068 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
10069 @cindex ARM926ej-s
10070
10071 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
10072 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
10073 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
10074 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10075 and ARM9 commands.
10076
10077 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
10078 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
10079
10080 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
10081 Print information about the caches found.
10082 @end deffn
10083
10084 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
10085 @cindex ARM966E
10086
10087 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
10088 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
10089 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10090 and ARM9 commands.
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
10093 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10094 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10095 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
10096 ARM966E-S TRM.
10097 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
10098 as required for BIST support.
10099 @end deffn
10100
10101 @subsection XScale specific commands
10102 @cindex XScale
10103
10104 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
10105
10106 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
10107 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
10108 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
10109 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
10110 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
10111 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
10112 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
10113
10114 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
10115 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
10116 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
10117 the mini-IC.
10118
10119 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
10120 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
10121 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
10122 code layout in memory:
10123 @example
10124 _vectors:
10125 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10126 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10127 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10128 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10129 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10130 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10131 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10132 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10133 .org 0x100
10134 .long real_reset_vector
10135 .long real_ui_handler
10136 .long real_swi_handler
10137 .long real_pf_abort
10138 .long real_data_abort
10139 .long 0 /* unused */
10140 .long real_irq_handler
10141 .long real_fiq_handler
10142 @end example
10143
10144 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
10145 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
10146 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
10147 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
10148 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
10149 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
10150 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
10151 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
10152 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
10153 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
10154 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
10155 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
10156 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
10157 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
10158 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
10159 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
10160 software.
10161
10162 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
10163 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
10164 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
10165 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
10166
10167 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
10168 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
10169 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
10170 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
10171 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
10172 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
10173 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
10174 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
10175 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
10176
10177 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
10178 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
10179
10180 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
10181 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
10182 @end deffn
10183
10184 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
10185 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
10186 @end deffn
10187
10188 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
10189 Displays information about the CPU caches.
10190 @end deffn
10191
10192 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
10193 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10194 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10195 @end deffn
10196
10197 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
10198 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
10199 @end deffn
10200
10201 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10202 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
10203 @end deffn
10204
10205 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
10206 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
10207 @end deffn
10208
10209 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10210 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
10211 @end deffn
10212
10213 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10214 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
10218 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
10219 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
10220 and modifying how it is emptied.
10221 @end deffn
10222
10223 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
10224 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
10225 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
10226 The image @var{type} may be one of
10227 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
10228 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
10229 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
10230 @end deffn
10231
10232 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
10233 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
10234 @cindex vector_catch
10235 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
10236 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
10237
10238 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
10239 @example
10240 0x01 Trap Reset
10241 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
10242 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
10243 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
10244 0x10 Trap Data Abort
10245 0x20 reserved
10246 0x40 Trap IRQ
10247 0x80 Trap FIQ
10248 @end example
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
10252 @cindex vector_table
10253
10254 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
10255 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
10256 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
10257 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
10258 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
10259
10260 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
10261
10262 @end deffn
10263
10264 @section ARMv6 Architecture
10265 @cindex ARMv6
10266
10267 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
10268 @cindex ARM11
10269
10270 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10271 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
10272 which is enabled by default.
10273 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10274 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
10275 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
10276 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
10277 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
10278 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
10279 @end deffn
10280
10281 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10282 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
10283 which is enabled by default.
10284 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10285 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
10286 @end deffn
10287
10288 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10289 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
10290 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
10291 they are disabled by default.
10292 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
10293 @end deffn
10294
10295 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
10296 @cindex vector_catch
10297 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
10298 coprocessor 14 register 7.
10299 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
10300
10301 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10302 for certain hardware events.
10303 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
10304 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
10305 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
10306 @end deffn
10307
10308 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
10309 @cindex ARMv7
10310 @cindex ARMv8
10311
10312 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
10313 @cindex Cortex-A
10314
10315 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
10316 display information about target caches
10317 @end deffn
10318
10319 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10320 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
10321 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
10322 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
10323 Defaults to 'off'.
10324 @end deffn
10325
10326 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
10327 Initialize core debug
10328 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10329 @end deffn
10330
10331 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
10332 Display/set the current SMP mode
10333 @end deffn
10334
10335 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
10336 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
10337 @end deffn
10338
10339 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10340 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10341 @end deffn
10342
10343 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
10344 configure l2x cache
10345 @end deffn
10346
10347 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
10348 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
10349 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
10350 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
10351 possible (4096) entries are printed.
10352 @end deffn
10353
10354 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
10355 @cindex Cortex-R
10356
10357 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
10358 Initialize core debug
10359 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10360 @end deffn
10361
10362 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10363 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366
10367 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
10368 @cindex tracing
10369 @cindex SWO
10370 @cindex SWV
10371 @cindex TPIU
10372
10373 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10374 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10375 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10376 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10377
10378 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10379 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10380 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10381 which causes quite some confusion.
10382 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10383 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10384
10385 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10386 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10387 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10388
10389 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10390 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10391 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10392 @end deffn
10393
10394 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10395 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10396 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10397 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10398
10399 @itemize @bullet
10400 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10401 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10402 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10403 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10404
10405 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10406 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10407 @end itemize
10408 @end deffn
10409
10410 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10411 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10412 @end deffn
10413
10414 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10415 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10416 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10417 at any time after the initialization, too.
10418 @end deffn
10419
10420 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10421 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10422 individually queried, to return its current value.
10423 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10424 @end deffn
10425
10426 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10427 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10428 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10429 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10430
10431 @itemize @bullet
10432 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10433 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10434
10435 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
10436 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10437 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10438
10439 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10440 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10441
10442 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10443 protocol used for trace data:
10444 @itemize @minus
10445 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10446 data bits (default);
10447 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10448 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10449 @end itemize
10450
10451 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10452 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10453 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10454 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10455 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10456 of the TPIU.
10457
10458 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10459 the destination of the trace data:
10460 @itemize @minus
10461 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10462 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10463 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10464 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10465 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10466 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10467 each connected client;
10468 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10469 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10470 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10471 @end itemize
10472
10473 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10474 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10475 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10476 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10477
10478 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10479 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10480 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10481 maximum supported rate automatically.
10482
10483 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10484 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10485 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10486
10487 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10488 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10489 default value is @var{0}.
10490 @end itemize
10491 @end deffn
10492
10493 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10494 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10495 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10496 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10497 data.
10498 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10499 after the @command{init}.
10500 @end deffn
10501
10502 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10503 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10504 @end deffn
10505
10506
10507
10508 Example usage:
10509 @enumerate
10510 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10511 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10512 enough to:
10513 @example
10514 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10515 ...
10516 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10517 ...
10518 @end example
10519 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10520 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10521 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10522 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10523 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10524 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10525 @example
10526 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10527 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10528 @end example
10529 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10530 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10531 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10532 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10533 @example
10534 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10535 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10536 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10537 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10538 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10539 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10540 @end example
10541 @end enumerate
10542
10543 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10544 @cindex tracing
10545 @cindex SWO
10546 @cindex SWV
10547 @cindex ITM
10548 @cindex ETM
10549
10550 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10551 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10552 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10553 @end deffn
10554
10555 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10556 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10557 @end deffn
10558
10559 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10560 @cindex Cortex-M
10561
10562 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10563 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10564
10565 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10566 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10567 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10568 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10569 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10570 the step command leaves with the core running.
10571
10572 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10573 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10574 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10575 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10576
10577 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10578 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10579 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10580 does.
10581
10582 Default is @option{auto}.
10583 @end deffn
10584
10585 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10586 @cindex vector_catch
10587 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10588 for certain hardware events.
10589
10590 Parameters request interception of
10591 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10592 @option{none} of them,
10593 or one or more of the following:
10594 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10595 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10596 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10597 @option{irq_err},
10598 @option{state_err},
10599 @option{chk_err}, or
10600 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10601 @option{reset}.
10602 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10603 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10604 are mapped to HardFault.
10605 UsageFault checks for
10606 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10607 must also be explicitly enabled.
10608
10609 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10610 @end deffn
10611
10612 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10613 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10614 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10615
10616 @itemize @minus
10617 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10618 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10619 @end itemize
10620
10621 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10622 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10623 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10624 to manually reset the peripherals.
10625 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10626
10627 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10628 instead.
10629 @end deffn
10630
10631 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10632 @cindex ARMv8-A
10633 @cindex aarch64
10634
10635 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10636 Display information about target caches
10637 @end deffn
10638
10639 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10640 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10641 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10642 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10643 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10644 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10645 @end deffn
10646
10647 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10648 @cindex disassemble
10649 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10650 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10651 @end deffn
10652
10653 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10654 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10655 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10656 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10657 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10658 @end deffn
10659
10660 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10661 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10662 @option{on}.
10663 @end deffn
10664
10665 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10666 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10667 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10668 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10669 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10670 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10671 @end deffn
10672
10673 @deffn {Command} {$target_name pauth} [@option{off}|@option{on}]
10674 Enable or disable pointer authentication features.
10675 When pointer authentication is used on ARM cores, GDB asks GDB servers for an 8-bytes mask to remove signature bits added by pointer authentication.
10676 If this feature is enabled, OpenOCD provides GDB with an 8-bytes mask.
10677 Pointer authentication feature is broken until gdb 12.1, going to be fixed.
10678 Consider using a newer version of gdb if you want to enable pauth feature.
10679 The default configuration is @option{off}.
10680 @end deffn
10681
10682
10683 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10684
10685 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10686 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10687
10688 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10689
10690 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10691 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10692 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10693 @end deffn
10694
10695 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10696 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10697 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10698 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10699 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10700 @end deffn
10701
10702 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10703
10704 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10705 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10706 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10707 @end deffn
10708
10709 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10710
10711 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10712 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10713 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10714 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10715 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10716 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10717 can be collected.
10718
10719 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10720 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10721 tooling.
10722
10723 @quotation Issues
10724 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10725 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10726 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10727 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10728
10729 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10730 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10731 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10732 software operation on the CPU.
10733 @end quotation
10734
10735 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10736 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10737 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10738 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10739 @end deffn
10740
10741 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10742 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10743 @end deffn
10744
10745 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10746 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10747 control is disabled.
10748 @end deffn
10749
10750 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10751 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10752 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10753 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10754
10755 Supported trace formats:
10756 @itemize
10757 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10758 timing to be determined.
10759 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10760 addresses.
10761 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10762 @end itemize
10763 @end deffn
10764
10765 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10766 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10767 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10768 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10769
10770 Supported conditions:
10771 @itemize
10772 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10773 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10774 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10775 instruction matches start data and mask.
10776 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10777 instruction matches start data and mask.
10778 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10779 data and mask.
10780 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10781 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10782 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10783 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10784 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10785 @end itemize
10786 @end deffn
10787
10788 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10789 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10790 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10791 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10792
10793 Supported conditions:
10794 @itemize
10795 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10796 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10797 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10798 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10799 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10800 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10801 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10802 data and mask.
10803 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10804 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10805 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10806 @end itemize
10807 @end deffn
10808
10809 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10810 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10811
10812 Supported triggers:
10813 @itemize
10814 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10815 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10816 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10817 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10818 collection.
10819 @end itemize
10820 @end deffn
10821
10822 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10823
10824 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10825 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10826 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10827 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10828 @end deffn
10829
10830 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10831 Display trace configuration.
10832 @end deffn
10833
10834 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10835 Display trace collection status.
10836 @end deffn
10837
10838 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10839 Start manual trace collection.
10840 @end deffn
10841
10842 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10843 Stop manual trace collection.
10844 @end deffn
10845
10846 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10847 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10848 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10849 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10850 @option{size} options using DMA.
10851 @end deffn
10852
10853 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10854 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10855 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10856 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10857 @option{size} options using DMA.
10858 @end deffn
10859
10860 @section Intel Architecture
10861
10862 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10863 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10864 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10865 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10866 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10867 @itemize
10868 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10869 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10870 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10871 @end itemize
10872
10873 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10874 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10875 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10876
10877 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10878 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10879 @end deffn
10880
10881 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10882 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10883 @end deffn
10884
10885 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10886 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10887 @end deffn
10888
10889 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10890 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10891 @end deffn
10892
10893 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10894 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10895 @end deffn
10896
10897 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10898 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10899 @end deffn
10900
10901 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10902
10903 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10904 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10905
10906 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10907 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10908 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10909 @end deffn
10910 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10911 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10912
10913 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10914
10915 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10916 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10917 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10918 @end deffn
10919
10920 @subsection Registers commands
10921 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10922 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10923 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10924
10925 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10926
10927 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10928 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10929 and "timer" groups.
10930
10931 @emph{example:}
10932 @example
10933 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10934 @end example
10935
10936 @end deffn
10937
10938 @section RISC-V Architecture
10939
10940 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10941 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10942 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10943 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10944 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10945 implement version 0.11.
10946
10947 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10948
10949 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10950 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10951 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10952
10953 @subsection Vector Registers
10954
10955 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10956 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10957 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10958 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10959 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10960 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10961 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10962 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10963 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10964
10965 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10966 follows:
10967
10968 @example
10969 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10970 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10971 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10972 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10973 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10974 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10975 <union id="riscv_vector">
10976 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10977 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10978 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10979 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10980 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10981 </union>
10982 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10983 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10984 ...
10985 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10986 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10987 </feature>
10988 @end example
10989
10990 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10991
10992 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10993 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10994 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10995 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10996 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10997 named @code{csr<n>}.
10998
10999 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
11000 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
11001 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
11002 CSRs.
11003
11004 @example
11005 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
11006 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
11007
11008 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
11009 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
11010
11011 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
11012 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
11013 @end example
11014 @end deffn
11015
11016 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
11017 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
11018 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
11019 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
11020 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
11021 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
11022 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
11023 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
11024
11025 @example
11026 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
11027 # under the name "custom16":
11028 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
11029
11030 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
11031 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
11032 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
11033
11034 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
11035 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
11036 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
11037 @end example
11038 @end deffn
11039
11040 @deffn {Command} {riscv info}
11041 Displays some information OpenOCD detected about the target.
11042 @end deffn
11043
11044 @deffn {Command} {riscv reset_delays} [wait]
11045 OpenOCD learns how many Run-Test/Idle cycles are required between scans to avoid
11046 encountering the target being busy. This command resets those learned values
11047 after `wait` scans. It's only useful for testing OpenOCD itself.
11048 @end deffn
11049
11050 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
11051 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
11052 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
11053 @end deffn
11054
11055 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
11056 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
11057 deasserted.
11058 @end deffn
11059
11060 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
11061 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
11062 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
11063
11064 Available methods are:
11065 @itemize
11066 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
11067 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
11068 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
11069 @end itemize
11070
11071 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
11072 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
11073
11074 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
11075 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
11076 @end deffn
11077
11078 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
11079 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
11080 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
11081 on physical memory.
11082 @end deffn
11083
11084 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
11085 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
11086 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
11087 performed on physical memory.
11088 @end deffn
11089
11090 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
11091 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
11092 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
11093 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
11094 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
11095 race condition problem in your code.
11096
11097 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
11098 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
11099 @end deffn
11100
11101 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
11102 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
11103 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
11104 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
11105 values.
11106
11107 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
11108 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
11109 and DBUS registers, respectively.
11110 @end deffn
11111
11112 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
11113 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
11114 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
11115 @end deffn
11116
11117 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
11118 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11119 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11120 @end deffn
11121
11122 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
11123 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11124 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11125 @end deffn
11126
11127 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
11128 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11129 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11130 @end deffn
11131
11132 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
11133
11134 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
11135 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
11136 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
11137 @example
11138 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
11139 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
11140 @end example
11141
11142 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
11143 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
11144 @end deffn
11145
11146 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
11147 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
11148 @end deffn
11149
11150 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
11151
11152 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
11153 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
11154
11155 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
11156 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
11157 @end deffn
11158
11159 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
11160 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
11161 @end deffn
11162
11163 @section ARC Architecture
11164 @cindex ARC
11165
11166 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
11167 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
11168 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
11169 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
11170 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
11171 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
11172 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
11173 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
11174 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
11175 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
11176 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
11177 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
11178 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
11179 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
11180 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
11181
11182
11183 @subsection General ARC commands
11184
11185 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
11186
11187 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
11188 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
11189 arguments:
11190
11191 @itemize @bullet
11192
11193 @item @code{-name} name
11194 @*Name of a register.
11195
11196 @item @code{-num} number
11197 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
11198
11199 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
11200 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
11201
11202 @end itemize
11203
11204 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
11205
11206 @itemize @bullet
11207
11208 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
11209 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
11210 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
11211 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
11212 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
11213 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
11214
11215 @item @code{-core}
11216 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
11217 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
11218 spaces.
11219
11220 @item @code{-bcr}
11221 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
11222 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
11223 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
11224 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
11225 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
11226
11227 @item @code{-type} type_name
11228 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
11229 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
11230
11231 @item @code{-g}
11232 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
11233 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
11234 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
11235 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
11236 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
11237
11238 @end itemize
11239
11240 @end deffn
11241
11242 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
11243 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
11244 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
11245 @end deffn
11246
11247 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
11248 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
11249 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
11250 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
11251 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
11252 startbit endbit}.
11253 @end deffn
11254
11255 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
11256 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
11257 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
11258 @end deffn
11259
11260 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
11261 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
11262 as an argument for a single command invocation.
11263 @end deffn
11264
11265 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
11266
11267 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
11268 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
11269 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11270 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11271
11272 @end deffn
11273
11274 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
11275 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
11276 registers.
11277 @end deffn
11278
11279 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
11280 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
11281 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11282 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11283
11284 @end deffn
11285
11286 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
11287 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
11288 registers.
11289 @end deffn
11290
11291 @section STM8 Architecture
11292 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
11293 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
11294
11295 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
11296 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
11297
11298 @section Xtensa Architecture
11299
11300 Xtensa is a highly-customizable, user-extensible microprocessor and DSP
11301 architecture for complex embedded systems provided by Cadence Design
11302 Systems, Inc. See the
11303 @uref{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip.html, Tensilica IP}
11304 website for additional information and documentation.
11305
11306 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processor implementations which can be customized by
11307 providing a core-specific configuration file which describes every enabled
11308 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
11309 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. OpenOCD also supports SMP
11310 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows configuring
11311 their debug interconnect (termed "break/stall networks"), which control how debug
11312 signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
11313 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). OpenOCD implements both generic Xtensa targets
11314 as well as several Espressif Xtensa-based chips from the
11315 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
11316
11317 OCD sessions for Xtensa processor and DSP targets are accessed via the Xtensa
11318 Debug Module (XDM), which provides external connectivity either through a
11319 traditional JTAG interface or an ARM DAP interface. If used, the DAP interface
11320 can control Xtensa targets through JTAG or SWD probes.
11321
11322 @subsection Xtensa Core Configuration
11323
11324 Due to the high level of configurability in Xtensa cores, the Xtensa target
11325 configuration comprises two categories:
11326
11327 @enumerate
11328 @item Base Xtensa support common to all core configurations, and
11329 @item Core-specific support as configured for individual cores.
11330 @end enumerate
11331
11332 All common Xtensa support is built into the OpenOCD Xtensa target layer and
11333 is enabled through a combination of TCL scripts: the target-specific
11334 @file{target/xtensa.cfg} and a board-specific @file{board/xtensa-*.cfg},
11335 similar to other target architectures.
11336
11337 Importantly, core-specific configuration information must be provided by
11338 the user, and takes the form of an @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} TCL script that
11339 defines the core's configurable features through a series of Xtensa
11340 configuration commands (detailed below).
11341
11342 This core-specific @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} file is typically either:
11343
11344 @itemize @bullet
11345 @item Located within the Xtensa core configuration build as
11346 @file{src/config/xtensa-core-openocd.cfg}, or
11347 @item Generated by running the command @code{xt-gdb --dump-oocd-config}
11348 from the Xtensa processor tool-chain's command-line tools.
11349 @end itemize
11350
11351 NOTE: @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} must match the target Xtensa hardware
11352 connected to OpenOCD.
11353
11354 Some example Xtensa configurations are bundled with OpenOCD for reference:
11355 @itemize @bullet
11356 @item Cadence Palladium VDebug emulation target. The user can combine their
11357 @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} with the provided
11358 @file{board/xtensa-palladium-vdebug.cfg} to debug an emulated Xtensa RTL design.
11359 @item NXP MIMXRT685-EVK evaluation kit. The relevant configuration files are
11360 @file{board/xtensa-rt685-jlink.cfg} and @file{board/xtensa-core-nxp_rt600.cfg}.
11361 Additional information is provided by
11362 @uref{https://www.nxp.com/design/development-boards/i-mx-evaluation-and-development-boards/i-mx-rt600-evaluation-kit:MIMXRT685-EVK,
11363 NXP}.
11364 @end itemize
11365
11366 @subsection Xtensa Configuration Commands
11367
11368 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtdef} (@option{LX}|@option{NX})
11369 Configure the Xtensa target architecture. Currently, Xtensa support is limited
11370 to LX6, LX7, and NX cores.
11371 @end deffn
11372
11373 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtopt} option value
11374 Configure Xtensa target options that are relevant to the debug subsystem.
11375 @var{option} is one of: @option{arnum}, @option{windowed},
11376 @option{cpenable}, @option{exceptions}, @option{intnum}, @option{hipriints},
11377 @option{excmlevel}, @option{intlevels}, @option{debuglevel},
11378 @option{ibreaknum}, or @option{dbreaknum}. @var{value} is an integer with
11379 the exact range determined by each particular option.
11380
11381 NOTE: Some options are specific to Xtensa LX or Xtensa NX architecture, while
11382 others may be common to both but have different valid ranges.
11383 @end deffn
11384
11385 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{iram}|@option{dram}|@option{sram}|@option{irom}|@option{drom}|@option{srom}) baseaddr bytes
11386 Configure Xtensa target memory. Memory type determines access rights,
11387 where RAMs are read/write while ROMs are read-only. @var{baseaddr} and
11388 @var{bytes} are both integers, typically hexadecimal and decimal, respectively.
11389 @end deffn
11390
11391 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{icache}|@option{dcache}) linebytes cachebytes ways [writeback]
11392 Configure Xtensa processor cache. All parameters are required except for
11393 the optional @option{writeback} parameter; all are integers.
11394 @end deffn
11395
11396 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmpu} numfgseg minsegsz lockable execonly
11397 Configure an Xtensa Memory Protection Unit (MPU). MPUs can restrict access
11398 and/or control cacheability of specific address ranges, but are lighter-weight
11399 than a full traditional MMU. All parameters are required; all are integers.
11400 @end deffn
11401
11402 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmmu} numirefillentries numdrefillentries
11403 (Xtensa-LX only) Configure an Xtensa Memory Management Unit (MMU). Both
11404 parameters are required; both are integers.
11405 @end deffn
11406
11407 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregs} numregs
11408 Configure the total number of registers for the Xtensa core. Configuration
11409 logic expects to subsequently process this number of @code{xtensa xtreg}
11410 definitions. @var{numregs} is an integer.
11411 @end deffn
11412
11413 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregfmt} (@option{sparse}|@option{contiguous}) [general]
11414 Configure the type of register map used by GDB to access the Xtensa core.
11415 Generic Xtensa tools (e.g. xt-gdb) require @option{sparse} mapping (default) while
11416 Espressif tools expect @option{contiguous} mapping. Contiguous mapping takes an
11417 additional, optional integer parameter @option{numgregs}, which specifies the number
11418 of general registers used in handling g/G packets.
11419 @end deffn
11420
11421 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtreg} name offset
11422 Configure an Xtensa core register. All core registers are 32 bits wide,
11423 while TIE and user registers may have variable widths. @var{name} is a
11424 character string identifier while @var{offset} is a hexadecimal integer.
11425 @end deffn
11426
11427 @subsection Xtensa Operation Commands
11428
11429 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (@option{on}|@option{off})
11430 (Xtensa-LX only) Mask or unmask Xtensa interrupts during instruction step.
11431 When masked, an interrupt that occurs during a step operation is handled and
11432 its ISR is executed, with the user's debug session returning after potentially
11433 executing many instructions. When unmasked, a triggered interrupt will result
11434 in execution progressing the requested number of instructions into the relevant
11435 vector/ISR code.
11436 @end deffn
11437
11438 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
11439 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
11440 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
11441 @end deffn
11442
11443 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
11444 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
11445 @itemize @bullet
11446 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
11447 signal from other cores.
11448 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
11449 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
11450 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
11451 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
11452 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11453 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
11454 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
11455 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
11456 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
11457 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
11458 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
11459 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
11460 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11461 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
11462 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11463 @end itemize
11464 @end deffn
11465
11466 @deffn {Command} {xtensa exe} <ascii-encoded hexadecimal instruction bytes>
11467 Execute arbitrary instruction(s) provided as an ascii string. The string represents an integer
11468 number of instruction bytes, thus its length must be even.
11469 @end deffn
11470
11471 @subsection Xtensa Performance Monitor Configuration
11472
11473 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
11474 Enable and start performance counter.
11475 @itemize @bullet
11476 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
11477 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
11478 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
11479 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
11480 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
11481 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
11482 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
11483 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
11484 whether to count.
11485 @end itemize
11486 @end deffn
11487
11488 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11489 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11490 @end deffn
11491
11492 @subsection Xtensa Trace Configuration
11493
11494 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11495 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11496 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11497 @itemize @bullet
11498 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11499 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11500 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11501 @end itemize
11502 @end deffn
11503
11504 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11505 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11506 @end deffn
11507
11508 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11509 Dump trace memory to a file.
11510 @end deffn
11511
11512 @section Espressif Specific Commands
11513
11514 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (start <destination> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11515 Starts
11516 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11517 Data will be stored to specified destination. Available destinations are:
11518 @itemize @bullet
11519 @item @code{file://<outfile>} - Save trace logs into file.
11520 @item @code{tcp://<host>:<port>} - Send trace logs to tcp port on specified host. OpenOCD will act as a tcp client.
11521 @item @code{con:} - Print trace logs to the stdout.
11522 @end itemize
11523 Other parameters will be same for each destination.
11524 @itemize @bullet
11525 @item @code{poll_period} - trace data polling period in ms.
11526 @item @code{trace_size} - maximum trace data size.
11527 Tracing will be stopped automatically when that amount is reached.
11528 Use "-1" to disable the limitation.
11529 @item @code{stop_tmo} - Data reception timeout in ms.
11530 Tracing will be stopped automatically when no data is received within that period.
11531 @item @code{wait4halt} - if non-zero then wait for target to be halted before tracing start.
11532 @item @code{skip_size} - amount of tracing data to be skipped before writing it to destination.
11533 @end itemize
11534 @end deffn
11535
11536 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (stop)
11537 Stops tracing started with above command.
11538 @end deffn
11539
11540 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (status)
11541 Requests ongoing tracing status.
11542 @end deffn
11543
11544 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (dump file://<outfile>)
11545 Dumps tracing data from target buffer. It can be useful to dump the latest data
11546 buffered on target for post-mortem analysis. For example when target starts tracing automatically
11547 w/o OpenOCD command and keeps only the latest data window which fit into the buffer.
11548 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11549 Data will be stored to specified destination.
11550 @end deffn
11551
11552 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (start file://<outfile1> [file://<outfile2>] [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11553 Starts @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView}
11554 compatible tracing. Data will be stored to specified destination.
11555 For dual-core chips traces from every core will be saved to separate files.
11556 Resulting files can be open in "SEGGER SystemView" application.
11557 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11558 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp apptrace start}.
11559 @end deffn
11560
11561 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (stop)
11562 Stops SystremView compatible tracing started with above command.
11563 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11564 @end deffn
11565
11566 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (status)
11567 Requests ongoing SystremView compatible tracing status.
11568 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11569 @end deffn
11570
11571 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (start file://<outfile> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11572 This command is identical to @command{esp sysview start}, but uses Espressif multi-core extension to
11573 @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView} data format.
11574 Data will be stored to specified destination. Tracing data from all cores are saved in the same file.
11575 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp sysview start}.
11576 @end deffn
11577
11578 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (stop)
11579 Stops Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing started with above command.
11580 @end deffn
11581
11582 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (status)
11583 Requests ongoing Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing status.
11584 @end deffn
11585
11586 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11587 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11588 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11589 @cindex tracing
11590 @cindex libdcc
11591 @cindex DCC
11592 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11593 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11594 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11595 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11596
11597 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11598 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11599 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11600 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11601 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11602 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11603
11604 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11605 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11606 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11607 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11608 The target being debugged may
11609 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11610 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11611 each supported by a command:
11612
11613 @itemize
11614 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11615 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11616 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11617 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11618
11619 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11620 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11621 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11622
11623 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11624 and then displayed at any time.
11625 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11626
11627 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11628 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11629 @end itemize
11630
11631 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11632 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11633 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11634 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11635 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11636 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11637 does the same thing.
11638
11639 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11640 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11641 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11642 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11643 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11644
11645 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11646 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11647 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11648 @end deffn
11649
11650 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11651 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11652 in the order they triggered.
11653 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11654 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11655 history records.
11656 @end deffn
11657
11658 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11659 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11660 they have been triggered.
11661 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11662 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11663 and associates it with that identifier.
11664
11665 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11666 are not related except by this command.
11667 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11668 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11669 @end deffn
11670
11671
11672 @node JTAG Commands
11673 @chapter JTAG Commands
11674 @cindex JTAG Commands
11675 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11676 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11677 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11678 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11679 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11680
11681 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11682 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11683
11684 @itemize @bullet
11685 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11686 devices such as a CPUs.
11687 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11688 standard state machine (in parallel)
11689 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11690 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11691 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11692 while the reading previous ones.
11693 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11694 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11695 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11696 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11697 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11698 registers.
11699 @end itemize
11700
11701 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11702
11703 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11704 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11705 the order of TAP state transitions.
11706 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11707 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11708 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11709 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11710 these commands are not available.
11711
11712 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11713 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11714 that specify the entire register.
11715 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11716 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11717 The return value holds the original value of each
11718 of those fields.
11719
11720 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11721 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11722 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11723 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11724 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11725
11726 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11727 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11728
11729 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11730 in that state.
11731 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11732 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11733 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11734
11735 @quotation Warning
11736 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11737 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11738 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11739 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11740 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11741 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11742 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11743 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11744 @end quotation
11745 @end deffn
11746
11747 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11748 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11749 This may be used for performance tuning.
11750
11751 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11752 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11753 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11754 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11755 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11756 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11757 @end deffn
11758
11759 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11760 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11761 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11762 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11763 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11764 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11765
11766 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11767 in that state.
11768 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11769 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11770 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11771
11772 @quotation Note
11773 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11774 register values, unlike data register values.
11775 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11776 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11777 @end quotation
11778 @end deffn
11779
11780 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11781 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11782 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11783 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11784 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11785 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11786 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11787 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11788 The final state must also be stable.
11789 @end deffn
11790
11791 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11792 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11793 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11794 Instructions often need some time
11795 to execute before they take effect.
11796 @end deffn
11797
11798 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11799 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11800
11801 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11802 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11803 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11804 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11805 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11806 @end deffn
11807
11808 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11809 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11810 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11811 must also be enabled.
11812 Default is enabled.
11813 @end deffn
11814
11815 @section TAP state names
11816 @cindex TAP state names
11817
11818 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11819 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11820 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11821 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11822
11823 @itemize @bullet
11824 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11825 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11826 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11827 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11828 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11829 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11830 through the data register
11831 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11832 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11833 for update or more shifting
11834 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11835 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11836 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11837 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11838 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11839 through the instruction register
11840 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11841 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11842 for update or more shifting
11843 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11844 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11845 @end itemize
11846
11847 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11848 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11849 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11850 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11851
11852 @itemize @bullet
11853 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11854 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11855 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11856 may not be as expected.
11857 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11858 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11859 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11860 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11861 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11862 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11863 @end itemize
11864
11865 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11866 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11867
11868 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11869 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11870 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11871 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11872
11873 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11874 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11875 @cindex SVF
11876
11877 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11878 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11879 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11880 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11881
11882 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{-quiet}] @
11883 [@option{-nil}] [@option{-progress}] [@option{-ignore_error}] @
11884 [@option{-noreset}] [@option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}}]
11885 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11886 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11887
11888 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11889 affect their semantics.
11890
11891 Command options:
11892 @itemize @minus
11893 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11894 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11895 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11896 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11897 @item @option{-quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11898 @item @option{-nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11899 on the real interface;
11900 @item @option{-progress} enable progress indication;
11901 @item @option{-ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11902 errors.
11903 @item @option{-noreset} omit JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) before executing
11904 content of the SVF file;
11905 @item @option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}} inject @var{cyclecount} number of
11906 additional TCLK cycles after each SDR scan instruction;
11907 @end itemize
11908 @end deffn
11909
11910 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11911 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11912 @cindex XSVF
11913
11914 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11915 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11916 Xilinx devices.
11917 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11918 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11919
11920 @quotation Important
11921 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11922 @end quotation
11923
11924 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11925 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11926 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11927 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11928 that TAP.
11929 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11930 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11931 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11932 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11933 @end deffn
11934
11935 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11936 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11937 after building the software.
11938 You may find them useful:
11939
11940 @itemize
11941 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11942 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11943 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11944 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11945 @end itemize
11946
11947 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11948 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11949 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11950 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11951 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11952 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11953 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11954
11955
11956 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11957 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11958 @cindex IPDBG
11959
11960 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11961 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11962 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11963 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11964 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11965 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11966
11967 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}] [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}]
11968 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11969
11970 Command options:
11971 @itemize @bullet
11972 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11973 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11974 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11975 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11976 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host will listen. The default is 4242 which is used when the option is not given.
11977 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub. The default is 1 which is used when the option is not given.
11978 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is reachable if there is a
11979 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11980 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11981 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11982 shift data through vir can be configured.
11983 @end itemize
11984 @end deffn
11985 or
11986 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-pld @var{name} [@var{user}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}]
11987 Also starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. The pld drivers are able to provide the tap and hub/IR for the IPDBG JTAG-Host server.
11988 With the @option{-pld @var{name} [@var{user}]} the information from the pld-driver is used and the options @option{-tap} and @option{-hub} are not required.
11989 The defined driver for the pld @var{name} gets selected. (The pld devices names can be shown by the command @command{pld devices}).
11990
11991 The @verb{|USERx|} instructions are vendor specific and don't change between families of the same vendor.
11992 So if there's a pld driver for your vendor it should work with your FPGA even when the driver is not compatible with your device for the remaining features. If your device/vendor is not supported you have to use the previous command.
11993
11994 With [@var{user}] one can select a different @verb{|USERx|}-Instruction. If the IPDBG JTAG-Hub is used without modification the default value of 1 which selects the first @verb{|USERx|} instruction is adequate.
11995
11996 The remaining options are described in the previous command.
11997 @end deffn
11998
11999 Examples:
12000 @example
12001 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
12002 @end example
12003 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
12004 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
12005
12006 @example
12007 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
12008 @end example
12009 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
12010 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
12011
12012 @example
12013 ipdbg -start -pld xc7.pld -port 5555 -tool 0
12014 @end example
12015 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 5555 which connects to tool 0 (data_up_0/data_down_0).
12016 The TAP and ir value used to reach the JTAG Hub is given by the pld driver.
12017
12018
12019 @node Utility Commands
12020 @chapter Utility Commands
12021 @cindex Utility Commands
12022
12023 @section RAM testing
12024 @cindex RAM testing
12025
12026 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
12027 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
12028 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
12029 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
12030 hardware problems.
12031
12032 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
12033 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
12034 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
12035 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
12036
12037 Load the memory testing functions with
12038
12039 @example
12040 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
12041 @end example
12042
12043 to get access to the following facilities:
12044
12045 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
12046 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
12047 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
12048 @end deffn
12049
12050 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
12051 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
12052 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
12053 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
12054 @end deffn
12055
12056 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
12057 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
12058 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
12059 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
12060 @end deffn
12061
12062 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
12063 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
12064 @end deffn
12065
12066 @section Firmware recovery helpers
12067 @cindex Firmware recovery
12068
12069 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
12070 devices recovery with JTAG.
12071
12072 For quickstart instructions run:
12073 @example
12074 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
12075 @end example
12076
12077 @node GDB and OpenOCD
12078 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
12079 @cindex GDB
12080 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
12081 to debug remote targets.
12082 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
12083
12084 @itemize
12085 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
12086 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
12087 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
12088 as shown in this chapter.
12089 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
12090 that also will probably need to be configured.
12091 @end itemize
12092
12093 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
12094 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
12095 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
12096 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
12097 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
12098 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
12099
12100 @section Connecting to GDB
12101 @cindex Connecting to GDB
12102 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
12103 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
12104 errors, which has since been fixed; see
12105 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
12106
12107 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
12108
12109 @enumerate
12110 @item
12111 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
12112 @example
12113 target extended-remote localhost:3333
12114 @end example
12115 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
12116
12117 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
12118 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
12119 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
12120
12121 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
12122 remote command above that becomes:
12123 @example
12124 tar ext :3333
12125 @end example
12126
12127 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
12128 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
12129 available through the command:
12130 @example
12131 target remote localhost:3333
12132 @end example
12133
12134 @item
12135 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
12136 @example
12137 target extended-remote | \
12138 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
12139 @end example
12140 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
12141 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
12142 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
12143 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
12144 @end enumerate
12145
12146 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
12147 GDB command line.
12148
12149 @section Sample GDB session startup
12150
12151 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
12152 than they do when you're debugging locally.
12153 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
12154 small ARM program.
12155 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
12156 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
12157
12158 @example
12159 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
12160 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
12161 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
12162 ...
12163 (gdb) monitor reset halt
12164 ...
12165 (gdb) load
12166 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
12167 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
12168 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
12169 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
12170 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
12171 (gdb) continue
12172 Continuing.
12173 ...
12174 @end example
12175
12176 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
12177 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
12178 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
12179 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
12180
12181 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
12182
12183 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
12184 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
12185 packet size and the device's memory map.
12186 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
12187 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
12188 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
12189
12190 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
12191 You may need to set those up by hand.
12192 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
12193 something like:
12194
12195 @example
12196 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
12197 @end example
12198
12199 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
12200
12201 @example
12202 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
12203 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
12204 @end example
12205
12206 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
12207 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
12208 do not have such restrictions.
12209
12210 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
12211 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
12212 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
12213 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
12214
12215 @section Programming using GDB
12216 @cindex Programming using GDB
12217 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
12218
12219 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
12220 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
12221 @example
12222 gdb_memory_map disable
12223 @end example
12224 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
12225 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
12226 working area.
12227
12228 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
12229 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
12230 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
12231 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
12232
12233 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
12234 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
12235
12236 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
12237 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
12238 @example
12239 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
12240 @end example
12241
12242 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
12243 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
12244
12245 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
12246 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
12247 will be used.
12248
12249 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
12250 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
12251 @example
12252 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
12253 @end example
12254 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
12255
12256 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
12257 can be used.
12258
12259 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12260 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12261 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
12262
12263 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
12264 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
12265 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
12266
12267 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
12268 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
12269 and GDB treats it as it were running.
12270 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
12271 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
12272 without any intrusion of the target process.
12273
12274 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
12275 Place following command after target configuration:
12276 @example
12277 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
12278 @end example
12279
12280 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
12281 switch off gdb_memory_map:
12282 @example
12283 gdb_memory_map disable
12284 @end example
12285
12286 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
12287 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
12288 @example
12289 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
12290 @end example
12291
12292 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
12293 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
12294
12295 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
12296 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
12297 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
12298 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
12299
12300 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
12301 previously shown variables.
12302
12303 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
12304 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
12305 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
12306 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
12307 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
12308
12309 @section RTOS Support
12310 @cindex RTOS Support
12311 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
12312
12313 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
12314 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
12315
12316 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
12317 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
12318 GDB commands.
12319
12320 @* An example setup is below:
12321
12322 @example
12323 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
12324 @end example
12325
12326 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
12327
12328 Currently supported rtos's include:
12329 @itemize @bullet
12330 @item @option{eCos}
12331 @item @option{ThreadX}
12332 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
12333 @item @option{linux}
12334 @item @option{ChibiOS}
12335 @item @option{embKernel}
12336 @item @option{mqx}
12337 @item @option{uCOS-III}
12338 @item @option{nuttx}
12339 @item @option{RIOT}
12340 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
12341 @item @option{Zephyr}
12342 @item @option{rtkernel}
12343 @end itemize
12344
12345 At any time, it's possible to drop the selected RTOS using:
12346 @example
12347 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos none
12348 @end example
12349
12350 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
12351 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
12352
12353 @table @code
12354 @item eCos symbols
12355 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
12356 @item ThreadX symbols
12357 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
12358 @item FreeRTOS symbols
12359 @raggedright
12360 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
12361 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
12362 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority, xSchedulerRunning.
12363 @end raggedright
12364 @item linux symbols
12365 init_task.
12366 @item ChibiOS symbols
12367 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
12368 @item embKernel symbols
12369 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
12370 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
12371 @item mqx symbols
12372 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
12373 @item uC/OS-III symbols
12374 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
12375 @item nuttx symbols
12376 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
12377 @item RIOT symbols
12378 @raggedright
12379 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
12380 _tcb_name_offset.
12381 @end raggedright
12382 @item Zephyr symbols
12383 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
12384 @item rtkernel symbols
12385 Multiple struct offsets.
12386 @end table
12387
12388 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
12389 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
12390
12391 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
12392 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
12393
12394 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
12395 along with the project:
12396
12397 @table @code
12398 @item FreeRTOS
12399 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
12400 @item uC/OS-III
12401 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
12402 @end table
12403
12404 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
12405 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
12406 @cindex SMP
12407 @cindex RTOS
12408 @cindex hwthread
12409 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
12410 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
12411 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
12412 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
12413 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
12414 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
12415 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
12416 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
12417 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
12418
12419 @node Tcl Scripting API
12420 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
12421 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
12422 @cindex Tcl scripts
12423 @section API rules
12424
12425 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
12426 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
12427 of state information as an argument to each proc.
12428
12429 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
12430 pair list and lists.
12431
12432 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
12433 list.
12434
12435 @example
12436 > set foo(me) Duane
12437 > set foo(you) Oyvind
12438 > set foo(mouse) Micky
12439 > set foo(duck) Donald
12440 @end example
12441
12442 If one does this:
12443
12444 @example
12445 > set foo
12446 @end example
12447
12448 The result is:
12449
12450 @example
12451 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
12452 @end example
12453
12454 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
12455
12456 @verbatim
12457 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
12458 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
12459 }
12460 @end verbatim
12461
12462 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
12463 should be passed in to the proc in question.
12464
12465 @section Internal low-level Commands
12466
12467 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
12468 invoke directly.
12469
12470 @itemize
12471 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
12472
12473 Return information about the flash banks
12474
12475 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
12476
12477 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
12478 its execution together with the command output. Example:
12479
12480 @example
12481 > capture "reset init"
12482 @end example
12483
12484 @end itemize
12485
12486 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
12487 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
12488 called "flash_banks".
12489
12490 @section Tcl RPC server
12491 @cindex RPC
12492
12493 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
12494 commands and receive the results.
12495
12496 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
12497 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
12498 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
12499 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
12500 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
12501
12502 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
12503 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
12504 @command{capture} command.
12505
12506 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
12507
12508 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
12509 @cindex RPC Notifications
12510
12511 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12512 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12513
12514 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
12515 in the following format.
12516
12517 @verbatim
12518 type target_event event [event-name]
12519 type target_state state [state-name]
12520 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
12521 @end verbatim
12522
12523 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
12524 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
12525 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12526 Defaults to off.
12527
12528 @end deffn
12529
12530 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
12531 @cindex RPC trace output
12532
12533 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12534 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12535
12536 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
12537
12538 @verbatim
12539 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
12540 @end verbatim
12541
12542 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
12543 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
12544 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12545 Defaults to off.
12546
12547 See an example application here:
12548 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
12549
12550 @end deffn
12551
12552 @node FAQ
12553 @chapter FAQ
12554 @cindex faq
12555 @enumerate
12556 @anchor{faqrtck}
12557 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
12558 @cindex RTCK
12559 @cindex adaptive clocking
12560 @*
12561
12562 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
12563 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
12564 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
12565 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
12566
12567 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
12568 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
12569 for example. There are 2 basic options:
12570 @enumerate
12571 @item
12572 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
12573 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
12574 @item
12575 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
12576 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
12577 @end enumerate
12578
12579 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
12580 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
12581 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
12582 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
12583 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
12584 power).
12585
12586 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
12587 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
12588 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12589 ARM926 scenario).
12590 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12591 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12592 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12593
12594 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12595 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12596 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12597 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12598
12599 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12600
12601 In order to make use of this,
12602 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12603 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12604
12605 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12606 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12607 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12608 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12609 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12610
12611 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12612 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12613 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12614 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12615
12616 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12617 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12618 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12619 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12620 with a CPLD.
12621 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12622 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12623 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12624 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12625 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12626 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12627
12628 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12629
12630 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12631
12632 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12633 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12634 depending on the chips on your board.
12635 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12636 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12637 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12638
12639 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12640 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12641 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12642
12643 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12644 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12645 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12646 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12647
12648 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12649 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12650 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12651 this way.
12652
12653 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12654 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12655 clock rate.
12656 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12657 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12658 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12659
12660 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12661
12662 @example
12663 # Example: 1.234MHz
12664 adapter speed 1234
12665 @end example
12666
12667
12668 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12669
12670 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12671 around Windows filenames.
12672
12673 @example
12674 > echo \a
12675
12676 > echo @{\a@}
12677 \a
12678 > echo "\a"
12679
12680 >
12681 @end example
12682
12683
12684 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12685
12686 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12687 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12688 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12689
12690 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12691 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12692 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12693
12694 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12695 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12696 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12697
12698 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12699
12700 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12701 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12702 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12703 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12704
12705 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12706 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12707 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12708
12709 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12710 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12711
12712 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12713 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12714 memory read caused data abort".
12715
12716 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12717 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12718 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12719 be done, feel free to add this here.
12720
12721 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12722 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12723 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12724 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12725 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12726 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12727 gracefully stops.
12728
12729 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12730 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12731 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12732
12733 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12734 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12735 bytes. Painful...
12736
12737
12738 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12739 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12740
12741 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12742 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12743 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12744 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12745 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12746 reset, everything else should work fine.
12747
12748 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12749 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12750 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12751 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12752
12753 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12754 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12755 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12756 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12757
12758 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12759
12760 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12761 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12762 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12763
12764 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12765 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12766
12767 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12768 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12769 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12770 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12771 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12772 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12773 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12774 clock frequency?
12775
12776 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12777 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12778 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12779 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12780 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12781
12782 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12783
12784 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12785 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12786 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12787 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12788 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12789 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12790 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12791
12792 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12793
12794 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12795 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12796 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12797 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12798
12799 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12800 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12801 particular order?
12802
12803 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12804 the same order used by the hardware.
12805
12806 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12807 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12808 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12809 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12810 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12811 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12812
12813 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12814 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12815 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12816 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12817
12818 @itemize @bullet
12819 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12820 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12821 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12822 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12823 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12824 @end itemize
12825
12826 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12827
12828 @itemize @bullet
12829 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12830 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12831 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12832 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12833 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12834 @end itemize
12835
12836
12837 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12838 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12839 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12840
12841 TODO.
12842
12843 @end enumerate
12844
12845 @node Tcl Crash Course
12846 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12847 @cindex Tcl
12848
12849 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12850 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12851 how the Tcl scripts work.
12852
12853 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12854 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12855 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12856 OpenOCD.
12857
12858 @section Tcl Rule #1
12859 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12860 @enumerate
12861 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12862 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12863 @end enumerate
12864
12865 The Tcl equal is this:
12866
12867 @enumerate
12868 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12869 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12870 @end enumerate
12871
12872 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12873 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12874
12875 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12876 There is a second pair of rules.
12877 @enumerate
12878 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12879 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12880 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12881 in Tcl.
12882 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12883 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12884 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12885 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12886 @end enumerate
12887
12888 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12889 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12890 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12891 Everything is a string}
12892
12893 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12894 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12895 difference is subtle.
12896 @enumerate
12897 @item Parse Time
12898 @item Evaluation Time
12899 @end enumerate
12900
12901 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12902 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12903 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12904
12905 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12906 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12907 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12908 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12909
12910 @itemize @bullet
12911 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12912 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12913 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12914 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12915 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12916 @example
12917 # bash example
12918 X=`date`
12919 echo "The Date is: $X"
12920 # Tcl example
12921 set X [date]
12922 puts "The Date is: $X"
12923 @end example
12924 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12925 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12926 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12927 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12928 is a string}
12929 @example
12930 set x "Dinner"
12931 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12932 @end example
12933 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12934 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12935 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12936 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12937 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12938 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12939 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12940 @end itemize
12941
12942 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12943
12944 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12945
12946 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12947
12948 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12949 the normal way.
12950
12951 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12952 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12953 line is immediately executed.
12954
12955 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12956 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12957
12958 @subsection Command Execution
12959
12960 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12961 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12962 control flow operators.
12963
12964 Commands are executed like this:
12965
12966 @enumerate
12967 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12968 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12969 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12970 @end enumerate
12971
12972 It sort of works like this:
12973 @example
12974 for(;;)@{
12975 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12976
12977 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12978
12979 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12980 @}
12981 @end example
12982
12983 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12984 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12985 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12986 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12987 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12988 ``LookupCommand()''
12989
12990 @subsection The FOR command
12991
12992 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12993 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12994 command just like any other command.
12995
12996 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12997 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12998 are:
12999
13000 @enumerate 0
13001 @item The ascii text 'for'
13002 @item The start text
13003 @item The test expression
13004 @item The next text
13005 @item The body text
13006 @end enumerate
13007
13008 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
13009 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
13010 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
13011 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
13012
13013 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
13014 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
13015
13016 @example
13017 int
13018 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
13019 int *argc,
13020 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
13021 @end example
13022
13023 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
13024 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
13025 still operates in the same basic way.
13026
13027 @subsection FOR command implementation
13028
13029 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
13030 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
13031
13032 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
13033
13034 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
13035
13036 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
13037 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
13038 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
13039
13040 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
13041 expression and returns a value.
13042
13043 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
13044 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
13045 @example
13046 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
13047
13048 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
13049
13050 int
13051 MyForCommand( void *interp,
13052 int argc,
13053 char **argv )
13054 @{
13055 if( argc != 5 )@{
13056 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
13057 return ERROR;
13058 @}
13059
13060 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
13061
13062 // Execute the start statement.
13063 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
13064
13065 // Top of loop test
13066 for(;;)@{
13067 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
13068 if( i == 0 )
13069 break;
13070
13071 // Execute the body
13072 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
13073
13074 // Execute the LOOP part
13075 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
13076 @}
13077
13078 // Return no error
13079 SetResult( interp, "" );
13080 return SUCCESS;
13081 @}
13082 @end example
13083
13084 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
13085 in the same basic way.
13086
13087 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
13088
13089 @subsection source and find commands
13090 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
13091 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
13092 @*Remember the parsing rules
13093 @enumerate
13094 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
13095 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
13096 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
13097 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
13098 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
13099 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
13100 That character begins Tcl comments.)
13101 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
13102 it reads a file and executes as a script.
13103 @end enumerate
13104 @subsection format command
13105 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
13106 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
13107 @b{sprintf()}.
13108 @b{Example}
13109 @example
13110 set x 6
13111 set y 7
13112 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
13113 @end example
13114 @enumerate
13115 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
13116 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
13117 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
13118 @* Refer to Rule #1
13119 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
13120 @* Refer to Rule #1.
13121 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
13122 @end enumerate
13123 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
13124 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
13125 @example
13126 #1 Good
13127 proc someproc @{@} @{
13128 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
13129 @}
13130 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
13131 #2 Good - no variables
13132 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
13133 #3 Good Curly Braces
13134 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
13135 puts "Time: [date]"
13136 @}
13137 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
13138 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
13139 @end example
13140 @enumerate
13141 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
13142 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
13143 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
13144 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
13145 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
13146 command.
13147 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
13148 @*There are 4 examples:
13149 @enumerate
13150 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
13151 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
13152 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
13153 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
13154 @end enumerate
13155
13156 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
13157 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
13158 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
13159
13160 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
13161 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
13162 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
13163 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
13164 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
13165 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
13166 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
13167 @end enumerate
13168 @subsection Global Variables
13169 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
13170 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
13171 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
13172 @example
13173 proc myproc @{ @} @{
13174 set y 0 #Local variable Y
13175 global x #Global variable X
13176 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
13177 @}
13178 @end example
13179 @section Other Tcl Hacks
13180 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
13181 @example
13182 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
13183 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
13184 # Create var name
13185 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
13186 # Make it a global
13187 global $vn
13188 # Set it.
13189 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
13190 @}
13191 @end example
13192 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
13193 @example
13194 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
13195 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
13196 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
13197 @}
13198 @end example
13199
13200 @node License
13201 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
13202 @include fdl.texi
13203
13204 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
13205 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
13206 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
13207 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
13208 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
13209 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
13210
13211 @printindex cp
13212
13213 @node Command and Driver Index
13214 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
13215 @printindex fn
13216
13217 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)